OCTOBER 1996
NAVFAC P - 405
SEABEE PLANNER’SAND ESTIMATOR’S
HANDBOOK
ii
DISTRIBUTION
SNDL Short Title Copies Each
23A3 COMUSNAVCENT Code N42 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 127G COMNAVSUPPFORANTARTICA . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 239B COMSECONDNCB/COMTHIRDNCB . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 239C NCR 20/NCR 31 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 439D NMCB 1, 7, 74, 133/ 3, 4, 5, 40 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1539E PHIBCB-ONE/PHIBCB-TWO . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 539F COMSECONDNCB DET Gulfport . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1FA32 CBU 410, 411, 412, 414, 415, 420, 423 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2FB41 CBU 405, 406, 409, 413, 416, 417, 418, 421 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2FF49 CBU 403, 422, 427 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2FKA1C NAVFACENGCOM CODE 12, 9152 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2FKN2 CBC Gulfport, Port Hueneme . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2FKN11 NFESC, Library Code L41 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1FR10 NCR 3, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 9 Det Hawaii, 20, 22, 30, 31 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2FR10 NMCB 14, 15, 17, 18, 21, . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5
NMCB 22, 23, 24, 25, 26, 27, 28 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5FT18 CBU 401, 402, 404, 407, 408 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2FT20 NCTC Gulfport Code 7110, Port Hueneme Code 9300-20 . . . . . . . . . . . . 5FT37 NAVSOCOLCECOFF . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5FT78 NETPMSA Code 0422 Professional Library . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1
HQ CINCSOUTH . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1
To obtain additional copies of the SEABEE CD-ROM send request to Commanding Officer(Code 153), Naval Construction Battalion Center, 1000 23Rd. Ave. Port Hueneme, CA93043-4301. For information call CESO Code 1574 DSN 551-2857, or Commercial (805)982-2857
iii
FOREWORD
The Seabee Planner's and Estimator's Handbook is a technical GUIDE for planningand estimating construction projects undertaken by the Naval Construction Force (NCF).The handbook provides information on estimating construction work elements and materialquantities, including equipment and manpower requirements.
Prepared by Seabees for Seabees, the handbook is specifically for use in typical Seabeeconstruction projects, and is designed for flexible application to projects of varying size, scope,and conditions. Tables for estimating labor have been provided to show the number of man-hoursrequired for each work function. Diagrams illustrate the functions of planning and estimating.Both tables and illustrations have been made as useful, accurate, and comprehensive as possible.
Abbreviations for measurements and quantities have been changed to conform to SupplyDepartment ordering requirements (not commercial abbreviations) to facilitate the orderingprocess. A glossary of abbreviations used, standard drawing symbols, and other professionalinformation needed by the planner or estimator are provided in the back of the handbook.
The addition to the P-405 HANDBOOK are work element code numbers. The codenumber is always bold and in the parenthesis, either to the right or directly below man-hour perunit. The unit is always ONE. This codes are used in the CBCM planning and estimatingsoftware.
This publication cancels and supersedes the Seabee Planner's and Estimator's Handbook,NAVFAC P-405, dated October 1994 and subsequent changes. Recommendations for revisionsfor improvement should be specific and forwarded to the Director, Civil Engineer Support Office,Naval Construction Battalion Center, 1000 23rd Avenue, Port Hueneme, California 93043-4301.This publication has been reviewed and approved in accordance with SECNAVINST 5600.16A.
B. D. NEALCAPTAIN, CEC, U.S. NAVYDirector, Manpower Managementand Seabee SupportNaval Facilities Engineering Command
iv
CHANGE RECORD
Change No. Date Title or brief description Signature of validation officer
v
CONTENTSPage
CHAPTER 1. INTRODUCTION TO PLANNING AND ESTIMATING . . . . . . . 1-11. Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-12. Definitions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-13. Data Required for Estimating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-34. Tables and Diagrams . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-3
CHAPTER 2. ACTIVITY AND QUANTITY ESTIMATES OF MATERIALS . . . 2-11. Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-12. Activity Estimates . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-23. Material Estimates . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-3
CHAPTER 3. EQUIPMENT ESTIMATES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-11. Application . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-12. Factors Affecting Production . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-13. Equipment Production Determination . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-24. Equipment Estimates . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-25. Table of Allowance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-66. Material Weights and Percent of Swell . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-10
CHAPTER 4. LABOR ESTIMATES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-11. Types of Labor Estimates . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-12. Checklists . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-23. Factors Affecting Production . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-24. Production Efficiency Guide Chart and Graph . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-35. Labor Estimating Tables . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-6
TABLES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . viii
CHAPTER 5. NETWORK ANALYSIS TECHNIQUES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-11. History . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-12. Network Analysis Advantages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-13. Network Analysis Disadvantages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-24. Project Planning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-35. Precedence Diagraming . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-56. Precedence Network Calculations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-87. Computer Use in the NCF . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-12
GLOSSARY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Glossary-1Units of Issue. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Glossary-3
BIBLIOGRAPHY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Bibliography-1
vi
Appendix A. Work Element Checklist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . A-1Appendix B. Equipment and Tool Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B-1Appendix C. Conversion and Waste Factors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . C-1Appendix D. Conversion Factors for English to Metric System . . . . . . . . . . . D-1Appendix E. Average Temperature and Rainfall Chart . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . E-1Appendix F. Standard Drawing Symbols . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . F-1Appendix G. Project Planning Steps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . G-1Appendix H. Forms . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . H-1INDEX . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Index-1
vii
FIGURES
Figure Title PageNumber
2-1 Estimating Work Sheet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-52-2 Bill of Material . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-62-3 BM/MTO Comparison Work Sheet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-72-4 Add-On BM Work Sheet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-83-1 Equipment Estimate Sample . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-44-1 Production Efficiency Graph . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-75-1 Typical Activity Block . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-55-2 Precedence Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-65-3 Representation of Lag . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-65-4 Start-to-Start Logic Connection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-75-5 Finish-to-Finish Logic Connection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-75-6 Forward Pass . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-95-7 The Backward Pass . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-95-8 Floats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-105-9 Start-to-Start . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-105-10 Finish-to-Finish . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-115-11 Typical Precedence Diagram for a 40- by 100-foot Rigid Frame Building . 5-13F-1 Title Symbols . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . F -3F-2 Standard Symbols . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . F -4F-3 Structural and Welding Symbols . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . F -5F-4 Architectural (Materials) Symbols . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . F -6F-5 Mechanical Symbols . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . F -9F-6 Electrical Symbols . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . F-13
viii
TABLES
Table Title PageNumber
3-1 NMCB TA-01 Construction Equipment Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-64-1 Production Efficiency Guide Chart . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-6
DIVISION 1. GENERAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-114-2 Asphalt Plant Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-134-3 Rock Crushing Plant Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-134-4 Scaffolding, Runways, and Ramps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-144-5 Temporary Construction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-14
DIVISION 2. SITE WORK . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-154-6 Acreage and Areas . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-174-7 Clearing, Stripping, and Grubbing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-184-8 Demolition and Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-194-9 General Excavation Factors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-204-10 Front End Loaders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-204-11 Bulldozer Production . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-214-12 Clamshell . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-214-13 Draglines . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-224-14 Trench Excavation Factors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-224-15 Power Excavators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-234-16 Trencher/Ditcher . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-234-17 Sheeting and Shoring Excavations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-244-18 Material Weights and Swell Factors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-254-19 Dump Trucks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-264-20 Wheel Tractor Scrapers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-264-21 Motor Graders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-274-22 Compaction Factors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-274-23 Rollers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-284-24 Seal Coats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-284-25 Bituminous Paving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-294-26 Rock Drilling and Blasting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-294-27 Hand Excavation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-304-28 Erosion Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-304-29 Landscaping . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-314-30 Fencing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-314-31 Concrete Culvert Pipe Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-324-32 Galvanized Culvert Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-324-33 Piled riving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-334-34 Miscellaneous Pier Hardware . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-33
ix
TABLES
Table Title PageNumber
DIVISION 2. SITEWORK (Continued)4-35 Wood Pile Dolphins . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-344-36 Pier Framing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-344-37 Pile Bracing and Capping . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-344-38 Pile Extraction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-35
DIVISION 3. CONCRETE CONSTRUCTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-374-39 Form Work . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-394-40 Reinforcing Steel Fabrication . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-404-41 Numbers, Sizes, Areas, and Weights of Bars . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-404-42 Placing Reinforcing Steel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-414-43 Mixing Concrete . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-424-44 Placing Concrete . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-434-45 Finishing and Curing Concrete . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-434-46 Miscellaneous and Imbedded Items . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-444-47 Concrete Requirements for Footings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-454-48 Volume Factors of Various Mixes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-454-49 Materials for 100 SF of Concrete . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-474-50 Concrete Requirements for Slabs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-474-51 Concrete Requirements for Walls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-484-52 How to Change Cubic Feet to Cubic Yard . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-494-53 Concrete Comprehensive Strength . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-504-54 Conversion and Waste Factors: Concrete Construction . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-514-55 Material Weights and Measures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-52
DIVISION 4. MASONRY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-534-56 Length of Concrete Masonry Walls by Stretcher . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-554-57 Height of Concrete Masonry Walls by Courses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-564-58 Block, Brick, and Rubble Masonry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-574-59 Tile Masonry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-584-60 Volume of Grout in Grouted Concrete Block Walls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-594-61 Maximum Unsupported Heights of CMU Wall During Construction . . . . 4-594-62 Masonry Conversion Units . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-604-63 Material Weights and Measures: Masonry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-61
x
TABLES
Table Title PageNumber
DIVISION 5. METALS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-634-64 Structural Steel Fabrication . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-654-65 Structural Steel Erection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-654-66 Flame Cutting Structural Steel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-664-67 Welding Structural Steel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-664-68 Install Steel Welded Pipe Lines . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-674-69 Gage Thickness and Weights of Black and Galvanized
Flat and Corrugated Sheets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-674-70 Weights of Steel Plates in Pounds per Square Foot . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-684-71 Weights of Standard Diamond Steel Floor Plates . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-684-72 Electrode and Wire Requirements for Horizontal Fillet Welds . . . . . . . . 4-684-73 Electrode and Wire Requirements for "V" Groove Butt Joints . . . . . . . . 4-694-74 Electrode and Wire Requirements for Square Groove Butt Joints . . . . . . 4-694-75 Weights of Flat Steel Bars in LBS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-704-76 Weights of Square and Round Bars in LBS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-714-77 Weights of Standard Channels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-724-78 Weights of Steel Angles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-734-79 Bolted Steel Tanks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-74
DIVISION 6. CARPENTRY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-754-80 Rough Carpentry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-774-81 Sheathing and Siding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-784-82 Number of Wood Joists Required for Any Floor Spacing . . . . . . . . . . . 4-794-83 Board Feet of Lumber Required per 100 Square Foot of Surface . . . . . . 4-804-84 Material Required for Built-Up Girders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-804-85 Board Feet Content . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-814-86 Board Feet Required for Wood Partitions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-824-87 Number of Studs Required for Variable Spacing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-824-88 Material Required for Rafters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-834-89 Roof Areas of Pitched Roof . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-844-90 Criteria for Plywood Roof Sheathing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-844-91 Criteria for Plywood Flooring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-854-92 Finish Carpentry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-864-93 Wire Nails: Length, and Approximate Number per Pound . . . . . . . . . . 4-86
xi
TABLES
Table Title PageNumber
DIVISION 7. MOISTURE PROTECTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-874-94 Waterproofing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-894-95 Sheet Metal Work . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-904-96 Insulation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-904-97 Fastener Requirements for Batts of Insulation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-914-98 Loose Fill Insulation Requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-91
DIVISION 8. DOORS, WINDOWS, AND GLASS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-934-99 Door Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-954-100 Window Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-964-101 Glass and Glazing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-96
DIVISION 9. FINISHES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-974-102 Portland Cement, Stucco, and Plaster . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-994-103 Material Requirements for Cement, Stucco, and Plaster . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-994-104 Acoustical Treatment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-994-105 Flooring and Tiling Soft . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1004-106 Estimating Floor Tile Requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1014-107 Floor Tile Waste Allowances . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1014-108 Mastic Requirements for Resilient Flooring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1024-109 Wall Covering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1024-110 Estimating Ready Mix Joint Compound and Tape . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1034-111 Estimating Fastener Requirements for Wallboard . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1034-112 Painting Structural and Miscellaneous Steel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1044-113 Fence Metal Painting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1044-114 Interior Painting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1054-115 Drying Times for Finished . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1064-116 Coverage for Paints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1074-117 Exterior Painting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-108
DIVISION 10. SPECIALTIES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1094-118 Install Partitions and Miscellaneous Metal Products . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1114-119 Bulletin Boards, Chalkboards, Directory Boards,
and Bathroom Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1114-120 Manufacture Wood Cabinets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-112
DIVISION 11. ARCHITECTURAL EQUIPMENT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-113
DIVISION 12. FURNISHINGS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-113
DIVISION 13. SPECIAL CONSTRUCTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-113
xii
TABLES
Table Title PageNumber
DIVISION 14. CONVEYING SYSTEMS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-113
DIVISION 15. MECHANICAL CONSTRUCTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1154-121 Install Cast Iron No Hub Pipe and Fittings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1174-122 Install Type K, L, and M Copper Pipe with
Cast or Wrought Fittings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1174-123 Install Threaded or Flanged Steel Pipe . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1184-124 Install Steel Grooved Pipe . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1194-125 Install CPVC and PVC Solvent Welded Pipe and Fittings . . . . . . . . . . 4-1204-126 Install Concrete Pipe . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1204-127 Install Pipe Insulation and Lagging . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1214-128 Finish Plumbing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1224-129 Install Compressed Air Systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1234-130 Install Fire Protection Systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1244-131 Install Galley Equipment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1244-132 Install Warm Air Furnaces . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1254-133 Install Heating Boilers, Expansion Tanks, and
Hot Water Storage Heaters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1264-134 Duct Sheet Metal and Fiberglass . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1274-135 Install Air Conditioners, Dehumidifiers, and Refrigerators . . . . . . . . . 4-1284-136 Refrigerant Recovery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-129
DIVISION 16. ELECTRICAL CONSTRUCTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1314-137 Electrical Line Work, General Information on Setting Poles . . . . . . . . 4-1334-138 Digging Pole and Anchor Holes, General Information . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1334-139 Overhead Primary and Secondary Conductors and Devices . . . . . . . . . 4-1344-140 Street and Security Lighting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1354-141 Athletic Facility Lighting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1364-142 Underground Power Systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1374-143 Electrical Rough In (Housing and Barracks) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1384-144 Electrical Finish and Trim (Housing and Barracks) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1394-145 Electrical Rough-In (Industrial) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1404-146 Conduit Spacing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1414-147 Electrical Finish and Trim (Industrial) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1414-148 Substation Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1424-149 Fire Alarm and Signal Systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1434-150 Overhead Telephone Line Construction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1444-151 Interior Telephone Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1444-152 Underground Telephone Line Construction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1454-153 Installing Intercommunication Systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-146
xiii
TABLES
Table Title PageNumber
DIVISION 17. EXPEDITIONARY STRUCTURES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1474-154 Tension Fabric Structures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1494-155 K-Span Buildings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-149
OTHER TABLESC-1 Conversion and Waste Factors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . C-3D-1 Conversion Factors for English to Metric System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . D-3D-2 Conduit and Wire Conversion Factors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . D-6D-3 Decimal Equivalent Chart . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . D-7D-4 Time Conversion Factors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . D-8E-1 Average Temperature and Rainfall Outside the United States . . . . . . . . . E-3E-2 Average Temperature and Rainfall for the United States . . . . . . . . . . . . E-5
xiv
This page is blank
1-1
CHAPTER 1. INTRODUCTION TO PLANNING AND ESTIMATING
1. INTRODUCTION. Good construction planning and estimating procedures are essentialto the ability of the Naval Construction Force (NCF) to accomplish quality construction that isresponsive to Fleet operational requirements. This handbook contains information which can beused to plan and estimate construction projects normally undertaken by Seabees; it is designedto be a helpful reference, not to establish procedures. The procedures described herein aresuggested methods that have been proven with use, and can result in effective planning andestimating. How and when these procedures are applied is left to the discretion of the user. Thetables are helpful references and are not intended to establish production standards. Thetables must be used with sound judgment and modified as the user's experience suggests. Man-hour tables are based upon direct labor and do not include allowances for indirect or overheadlabor.
2. DEFINITIONS. Users of this handbook should be familiar with the definitions and theirusage that follow.
a. Planning is the process to determine requirements and to devise and developmethods and schemes of action for construction of a project. A good construction plan is acombination of the activity, material, equipment and manpower estimates, plant layout, materialdelivery and storage, work schedules, quality control, specialty tools, environment protection,safety, and progress control.
b. Estimating is the process to determine the amount and type of work to beperformed and the quantities of material, labor, and equipment needed. The lists of thesequantities are called estimates.
c. Preliminary estimates are made from limited information, such as generaldescriptions of projects, or preliminary plans and specifications with little or no detail.Preliminary estimates are usually prepared to establish costs for budget purposes and to programmanpower requirements.
d. Detailed estimates are precise statements of quantities of materials, equipment,and manpower required to construct a given project. Underestimation of quantities can causeserious delays in construction or result in unfinished projects. A detailed estimate must beaccurate and be at the smallest level of detail to correctly quantify the requirements.
e. Activity estimates consist of a list of all the steps required to construct a givenproject, and includes specific, descriptive information as to the limits of each clearly definablequantity of work (activity). Activity quantities provide the basis to prepare the material,equipment, and manpower estimates. Activities are used in the scheduling process to provide thebasis to schedule material deliveries, equipment, and manpower. Errors in activity estimates canmultiply many times through their use in the preparation of other estimates and schedules.
f. Material estimates consist of a list and description of various materials and the
1-2
quantities required to construct a given project. Information to prepare material estimates isobtained from the activity estimates, drawings, and specifications. A material estimate issometimes referred to as a Bill of Material (BM) or a Material Take Off (MTO).
g. Equipment estimates consist of a list of the various types of equipment, theamount of time, and the number of pieces required to construct a given project. Information fromactivity estimates, drawings, specifications, and information obtained from inspection of the siteprovide the basis to prepare the equipment estimates.
h. Manpower estimates consist of a list of the number of direct labor man-daysrequired to complete the various activities of a specific project. These estimates may show onlythe man-days for each activity, or they may be in sufficient detail to list the number of man-daysof each rating (Builder, Construction Electrician, Equipment Operator, Steelworker, and Utilitiesman) for each activity. Man-day estimates are used to determine the number of men and ratingsrequired on a deployment, and provide the basis to schedule manpower in relation to constructionprogress. A man-day is a unit of work performed by one man in 8 hours.
I. Direct labor includes all labor expended directly on assigned construction tasks,either in the field or in the shop, which contributes directly to the completion of the end product.Direct labor must be reported separately for each assigned construction task.
j. Indirect labor is labor required to support construction operations, but does notproduce and end product itself.
k. Overhead labor is not considered to be productive labor because it does notcontribute directly or indirectly to the end product. It includes all labor that must be performed,regardless of the assigned mission.
l. An estimator is one who evaluates the requirements to do a task. A constructionestimator must be able to mentally picture the separate operations of the job as the work wouldprogress through the various stages of construction. The estimator must be able to read and obtainmeasurements from drawings. The estimator must also possess a knowledge of mathematics,have previous construction experience and a working knowledge of all branches of construction.The estimator should have good judgment when determining what effect numerous factors andconditions will have on construction of the project and what allowances should be made for eachof them, and be able to do accurate work. A Seabee estimator must have access to informationabout materials, equipment, and labor that is required to perform various types of work underconditions encountered in Seabee deployments. The collection of such information onconstruction performance is part of the job of estimating. Reference information of this kind maychange from time to time and, therefore, should be reviewed frequently.
m. Scheduling is the process to determine when an action must be taken, and whenmaterials, equipment, and manpower will be required. A progress schedule coordinates all
1-3
projects of a Seabee deployment, or all activities of a single project. It shows the sequence, thetime for starting, the time required for performance, and the time for completion. Materialschedules show when materials are needed on the job and may show the order in which theyshould be delivered. An equipment schedule coordinates all equipment to be used on a projectand shows when, and the amount of time, each type of equipment is required to perform the work. A manpower schedule coordinates the manpower requirements of a project and shows thenumber of men required for each activity for each period of time. The number of each rating(Builder, Construction Electrician, Equipment Operator, Steelworker, and Utilities man) requiredfor each activity for each period of time may also be shown. The selected unit of time to beshown in a schedule should be some convenient interval such as a day, week, or month.
n. Network analysis is a method to plan and control projects by recording theirinterdependence in a diagrammatic form that enables each fundamental problem involved to beundertaken separately. The diagrammatic form, known as a "network diagram," is drawn so thateach task is represented by a "box" on the diagram. The boxes are linked with lines whichindicate the dependencies of the tasks to each other.
o. Progress control is the comparison of actual progress with scheduled progress,and the steps necessary to correct deficiencies and to balance activities to meet overall objectives.
3. DATA REQUIRED FOR ESTIMATING. In order for the estimator to prepare adetailed and accurate estimate, information must be available about various conditions that affectconstruction of the project. The drawings should be detailed and complete. The specificationsshould be exact and leave no doubt as to their intent. Information should be available about localmaterials, quarries, gravel pits, borrow pits, spoil areas, types of soil, haul roads and distances,foundation conditions, weather conditions to be expected during construction, and time allottedfor completion. The amount and types of construction equipment available for use should beknown. Other items and conditions which might affect production or progress of constructionshould also be considered.
4. TABLES AND DIAGRAMS. Tables and diagrams save time in the preparation ofestimates and, when understood and used properly, give accurate results. The tables anddiagrams in this handbook are based on Seabee experience whenever possible. Where suitableinformation was not available, construction industry experience was adjusted to representproduction under the range of conditions encountered in Seabee construction. In the ManHour/Unit columns there are two numbers, first is the man hour/unit and the second one, inparenthesis, is the work element code number. Work element number is used with CBCMplanning and estimating program.
1-4
This page is blank
2-1
CHAPTER 2. ACTIVITY AND QUANTITY ESTIMATES OF MATERIALS
1. ACCURACY. The estimator needs a thorough knowledge of the project drawings andspecifications, and be alert to the various areas where estimating errors may occur.
a. Examination of Drawings. Accurate estimating requires a thorough examinationof the drawings. Information found on drawings is the main basis to define the required activitiesand to measure quantities. All notes and references should be carefully read and all detail andreference drawings examined. Dimensions shown or drawn should be used in preference toscaling. If it is necessary to scale dimensions, a scale rule should be used and the graphic scaleon the drawings should be checked for expansion or shrinkage of the drawing. When there isdisagreement between the plans, elevations, and details, the detail drawing normally is followed.When there is disagreement between the specifications and the drawings, the specificationsnormally are followed.
b. Examination of Specifications. Specifications must be used with the drawingsto prepare the estimates for activity, equipment, and quantity. The estimator must be familiarwith all the requirements contained in specifications, such as unfamiliar work procedures ormaterials, and the specific requirements concerned with testing. The estimator may find itnecessary to read the specifications several times to fix these requirements in mind. Notes madewhile reading the specifications prove helpful when the drawings are examined. Specificationsoften contain information required to prepare purchase requisitions and this should be used toprepare material lists. Wrong interpretation of a section of the specifications can cause errors inthe estimate. If there is any doubt about the meaning of any portion of the specifications, theestimator should request an explanation.
c. Need for Accuracy. Quantity estimates are used to purchase materials and todetermine equipment and manpower requirements. The use of quantity estimates in thescheduling process provides the basis for material deliveries, equipment, and manpower use.Because of the widespread use of quantity estimates, accuracy during preparation is veryimportant, since errors tend to become larger. For instance, if the estimator misread a dimensionfor one side of a concrete slab as 30 feet instead of 300 feet and the other dimensions was 100feet, the quantity estimate would show 3,000 square feet instead of the actual 30,000. Thisquantity would then be used to order the required construction materials such as cement, sand,and reinforcing steel, and as the basis for equipment and manpower requirements. This one errorwould be the source of short estimates and future problems.
d. Checking Estimates. The need for accuracy in quantity estimates requires thatthey be checked to eliminate as many errors as possible. One of the best ways to check, is tohave another person make an independent estimate and then compare the estimates aftercompletion. Any differences should be checked and corrected.
2-2
e. Sources of Errors. The most common source of errors follow:
(1) Failure to read all notes and references on a drawing results in incompleteestimates. For example, an estimator may overlook a note "Symmetrical about 0" and thuscompute only one-half the quantity.
(2) Errors in scaling drawings mean wrong quantities. Be sure that the correctmeasurements are recorded. Common errors are: using the wrong scale; reading the wrong sideof a scale; and failure to note that the detail being scaled is drawn to a different scale than the restof the drawing. Some drawings are not drawn to scale and may have the note "NTS" (not toscale), and the estimator must then obtain his measurements elsewhere.
(3) Omissions are usually the result of a careless examination of the drawings.Thoroughness in examining drawings and specifications eliminates omissions. A checklist mustbe used to ensure that all work elements or materials have been included. Drawings frequently arerevised after the Material Take Off (MTO). The estimate must be updated to reflect the revisions.
(4) Failure to make the proper allowance for waste and loss of constructionmaterials results in wrong estimates.
2. ACTIVITY ESTIMATES. Activity estimates provide a basis to prepare estimates ofmaterial, equipment, and manpower requirements.
a. Application. The activity estimate, for example, might call for an 8-inch concretemasonry unit (CMU) wall to be constructed. In the materials estimate, this would be convertedinto required quantities of sand, cement, lime, and 8-inch CMU block. In the equipment estimateit would be converted into mixer time required to mix the mortar. In the manpower estimate theactivity quantity would be converted into the number of man-days required to perform the work.The quantity of CMU, together with information on work sheets (such as length and height of wall)would be used to estimate the number of scaffold frames and scaffold boards required, togetherwith requirements of special tools. Information shown in activity estimates is used to schedulematerial deliveries, equipment and manpower, and is also used to schedule progress.
b. Suggested Procedure. The following procedures have been proven with use, andthe estimator will find that it will produce satisfactory results.
(1) A general knowledge of the project is obtained by studying the drawings,reading the specifications, and examining all available information that concerns site and localconditions. The estimator is ready to identify individual activities only offer first becomingfamiliar with the project.
(2) After becoming familiar with the project and defining its scope, theestimator proceeds to identify individual activities required to construct the project. To identify
2-3
activities, ensure that each activity description indicates a specific quantity of work, with cleardefinite limitations or cut-off points that can be readily understood by everyone concerned withthe project. A list of these activities is prepared in a logical sequence to check for completeness.
(3) The estimator must first define activities. An activity is a clearly definablequantity of work. For estimating and scheduling purposes, an activity should be a specific taskor work element accomplished by a single trade.
3. MATERIAL ESTIMATES. Material estimates are used as for construction materialprocurement, and as a check to determine if sufficient materials are available to construct orcomplete a project.
a. Application. The Operations Officer, for example, may have some doubts aboutthe availability of materials and request than an estimate be prepared that lists material quantitiesrequired to complete the project. This estimate is then compared with the stock of materials onhand to determine any shortages.
b. Typical Estimating Forms. The sample forms shown in figures 2-1, 2-2, 2-3,and 2-4 may be used to prepare material estimates. The forms are presented as one method torecord the various steps taken to prepare a material estimate. Each step can readily be understoodby others when reading the work sheets. A work sheet must have a heading that shows theproject title, project location, drawing number, project section, prepared by, checked by, anddate. Forms for reproductions are in appendix H.
(1) Estimating work sheet (figure 2-1) shows the various individual activitiesfor a project with a list of the required materials. When materials are scheduled for severalactivities or uses, show it in the remarks section. The work sheet should show activitydescription, item number, material description, unit of issue, waste factors, total quantities, andremarks. Retain the estimating work sheets for use by the field supervisor when construction isunderway to ensure use of materials as planned.
(2) Bill of Material (BM) sheet (figure 2-2) contains information presented ina format suitable for data processing. Requests for supply status, issue, or location of materialsuse this form. Bill of Material sheets are used to prepare purchase documents, and when fundingdata have been added, to draw from existing supply stocks.
(3) BM/MTO comparison work sheet (figure 2-3) is used to compare theindependent Material Take Off (MTO) with the BM. It should contain activity number,
2-4
material description, unit of issue (UI), BM line item number (BMLI), BM quantity, MTOquantity, difference between the two (BM/MTO), and remarks. If differences exist they shouldbe reconciled.
(4) Add-on BM (figure 2-4) is used to reconcile differences found in theBM/MTO comparison. It should be used for both add-ons or reorders. If it is a reorder stateso on the form.
c. Waste and Loss Factors. Between the procurement of construction materials andfinal installation, materials are subject to loss and waste. This loss may occur during shipping,handling, or storage. Waste is inevitable where materials are subject to cutting or final fitting prior to installation. Frequently, materials such as lumber, conduit, or pipe have astandard issue length, which is longer than required. More often than not, the excess is too short for use and end as waste. Waste and loss factors vary, depending on the individual item,and must be checked against the conversion and waste factors (see appendix C).
d. Checklist. Checklists are used to eliminate omissions from material estimates.The estimators should prepare a list for each individual project when examining the drawings,specifications, and activity estimates. This is the practical way to prepare a list of the variety ofmaterials used in a project. The list applies only to the project for which it has been prepared.If no mistakes or omissions have been made in the checklist or estimate, the material estimate willcontain a quantity for each item on the list.
e. Long Lead Items. Long lead items are those which are not readily availablethrough the normal supply system, and require special attention by the estimator to ensuredelivery at the required time. Items that require long lead time are those which are not shelfitems such as steam boilers, special door and window frames, items larger than the standardissue, and electrical transformers for power distribution systems. It is recommended that theseitems be identified and ordered early. Periodic checks must be made about the status of the orderto avoid delays in completion of the project.
f. Suggested Procedure. The suggested procedure for the preparation of a MaterialEstimate is to use the activity description together with the detailed information given in or on thedrawings to provide a quantity of work. This quantity is then converted to materials required.Next, the conversion should be on a work sheet to show how each quantity was obtained (figure2-1). Work sheets need to be sufficiently detailed to be self-explanatory. Allowances for wasteand loss are added after the total requirement is determined. All computations should appear onthe estimate work sheet, as must all notes relative to the reuse of materials. Material quantitiesfor similar items of a project are entered on the Bill of Material (figure 2-2) and becomes theMaterial Estimate for the project.
2-5
ESTIMATOR WORK SHEET
PROJECT LOCATION PROJECT TITLE PROJECT NUMBER BM DATE PREPAREDNUMBER
PROJECT SECTION ACTIVITY NUMBER DRAWING NUMBER PREPARED BY: CHECKED BY:
DESCRIPTION REMARKSBM UNIT TOTAL
LINE OF QTYITEM ISSUE
FIGURE 2-1. Estimating Work Sheet
2-6
BILL OF MATERIALPROJECT PROJECT TITLE AUTHORITY/ORIGINATOR BM NO. SECTION
M&S DEM SIG FUND DIS PRJ PRI JON ROSSERV & SERV &REQNR SUPP ADD ACCOUNTING DATA
7 30-35 44 45-50 51 53-53 54 57-59 60-61 62-64 72-77
COG NSN QTY DOCUMENT NUMBER ADVUNITOF
ISSUE
LI
DESCRIPTIONVENDOR/SOURCE UNIT TOTAL
INTENDED USE PRICE COST55-56 8-20 23-24 25-26 36-43 65-66
BM SUBMITTED BY/DATE BM APPROVED BY/DATE TARGET APPROVED/DATE PAGE BM TOTAL PAGETOTAL
OF
FIGURE 2-2. Bill of Material
2-7
BM/MTO COMPARISON WORK SHEETACTIVITY MATERIAL BM LI BM MTO
NO. DESCRIPTION NO. QTY QTYU/I DIFF REMARKS
FIGURE 2-3. BM/MTO Comparison Work Sheet
2-8
ADD-ON BMPROJECT NUMBER PROJECT TITLE DATE MLO USE ONLY
BM NUMBER MASTER ACTIVITY NUMBER DRAWING NO. PREPARED BY: UNIT TOTAL REQUESITIONPRICE COST NUMBER
BM UNITITEM OF QTY DESCRIPTION JUSTIFICATIONNO. ISSUE
1. CREW LEADER DATE 5. OPS DATE MLO NOTES & REMARKS
2. PROJECT SUP. 6. MLO CHIEF
3. PROJECT MGR. 7. MLO SK
4. QC REP. 8. PROCUREMENT APPROVAL
FIGURE 2-4. Add-On BM Work Sheet
3-1
CHAPTER 3. EQUIPMENT ESTIMATES
1. APPLICATION. Equipment estimates are used with project schedules to determine theconstruction equipment requirements and constraints for a Seabee deployment.
2. FACTORS AFFECTING PRODUCTION. Equipment estimators must be familiar withthe following definitions and how they affect production.
a. Permissible speeds are established either by a governing authority, as in a highwayor street speed limit, or by a command, such as in an operating limit on the equipment. In eithercase, the speed limits must be considered when estimating the average hauling speed which, inturn, determines the amount of material the equipment will move in one day. The estimatorshould not make the mistake of using the speed limit as the average speed at which equipment willbe operated. Equipment speed usually averages 40 to 65 percent of speed limits, depending uponfactors such as the condition of the road, number of intersections to be crossed, amount of traffic,and length of haul. Long hauls usually result in higher average speeds, other conditions beingequal.
b. The type of material to be handled has a definite effect on the amount of timerequired. For example, wet, sticky clay is slower to handle because it sticks to the bucket, pan,or truck bed and requires jarring and shaking to loosen and dump the load. On the other hand,damp, sandy loam does not stick to equipment as readily and requires little or no jarring orshaking; therefore, the time required for this extra effort is saved. Sand handles easier andquicker with a clamshell bucket than does gravel or crushed rock. When lifting with a crane,bulky, hard-to-rig material and equipment require more time to load and unload. Several triallifts usually are required, moving the slings after each lift before the equipment is balanced forsafe lifting.
c. Safety factors limit the amount of work which can be produced with a machine and,therefore, they must be considered as a production factor. Although the manufacturer's cranerating may show it to be capable of lifting 40 tons with a 70-foot boom at a 45-degree angle, forreasons of safety the maximum lifting capacity of that particular crane may have been limited to85 percent of the okay rating. The crane can then only be used to lift 34 tons with a 70-footboom at a 45-degree angle. Certain pieces of equipment which may have the speed limitedbecause of safety reasons will reduce the rate of production.
d. Operator experience must be considered when estimating equipment production.An experienced operator spreads a load of dirt with less passes than an inexperienced operator,and does a better job of spreading. Also, inexperienced operators are more inclined to forgetsome of the required maintenance operations and tend to cause more equipment downtime.
3-2
e. Age and condition of equipment must be considered in estimating the number ofdays required to perform work. Old or poorly maintained equipment has more downtime thannew equipment or equipment in good operating condition. Also, worn equipment responds moreslowly to the operator, has less power, and is generally less efficient. Downtime of equipmentsometimes affects more than just its own operation. For example, if one of five trucks haulingdirt broke down, it would affect only its own operation, but, if the equipment loading those fivetrucks broke down, it would stop all of the trucks plus the equipment spreading and compactingthe dirt being hauled.
f. Completion time affects production if crews must work long hours daily, or if thework must be performed under crowded conditions in order to complete the project within theallotted time. More efficient operation and better production is usually obtained by working twoor more shifts per day.
g. Climate has a considerable effect on production of equipment working outside.Rain slows down the work, and frequently stops it for the remainder of the day, and sometimesfor several days. In climates with considerable rainfall, equipment does not produce as much perhour or per week as in dry climates. Extremely cold weather slows down the operator and lowersthe efficiency of the equipment, thus lowering production.
3. EQUIPMENT PRODUCTION DETERMINATION. Production rates are usuallyavailable for equipment assigned. It is not practical to draw up a production table to consider theparticular combination of factors that affect production on a given project. Production rates inthe tables of this handbook must be adjusted to fit the conditions expected on each project. Inorder to make this adjustment the estimator should know on what basis the rate in the table wasestablished. The production rates found in the tables are an average of commercial manufacturersand government planning sources combined with, and adjusted to, the Naval Construction Force(NCF) productivity.
4. EQUIPMENT ESTIMATES. It is not practical to use a form with columns for workquantities, equipment quantities, and operator days when preparing the equipment estimate.However, forms with certain information in the heading will save the estimator time. Theheading should show that it is an equipment estimate with the following information: sheetnumber, estimator's name, date estimated, the checker's name, date checked, battalion anddetachment number, location of deployment, year of deployment, project number, project titleand activity description. Examples of such a form to estimate equipment required for "cut andfill" operations are shown in figure 3-1.
The activity estimate must be examined and all activities that require equipment listed.Each activity on this list should be treated in the following manner.
3-3
a. The type of equipment and method of performing the work should be selected.
b. The production rate per day should be estimated for each piece of equipment,considering all factors discussed in paragraph 2, and using information obtained from sourcesmentioned in paragraph 3, or based on the estimator's experience.
c. To find out how many days of equipment operation are required to perform thework, the quantity of work is divided by the production per day. Some elements of work requireseveral items of equipment to be used as a group, rather than individually, and in these cases, thedays of operation should be shown as days of group operation.
If one end loader and five trucks are to be used for 10 days loading and hauling earth fill, theywould be shown as one end loader and five trucks for 10 days, not as 10 days of end loading timeand 50 days of truck time.
d. The project schedule should be consulted to find the time allotted for completionof the activity after determination of the number of days of equipment operation required. Inorder to complete the work within the time scheduled, it may be necessary to work several piecesor groups of equipment at the same time. The result is a more efficient operation.
e. An equipment schedule should be prepared for the total deployment using theproject schedule to determine when the work will be performed. The schedule will indicate thepeak loads for each equipment type. A study of the peak loads may show that it is desirable torevise the project schedule to more evenly distribute the equipment work load and thereby reducethe amount of equipment required for deployment. For example, an equipment schedule shows80 dump trucks required during May and 20 dump trucks required during June and July. It maybe possible to revise the project schedule to evenly distribute the work for these dump trucks overthe three months so that 40 dump trucks are required during May, June, and July. This wouldmean a reduction of 40 dump trucks needed for the total deployment.
f. A list of the equipment requirements for the deployment can be prepared followinga review of the equipment and project schedules, and making all possible adjustments to them. In preparing this list, downtime should be anticipated and sufficient equipment added so thatwhen equipment is out of service awaiting repairs, a reserve piece is available for use. Thenumber of pieces of equipment required for a deployment is obtained by adding the requiredreserve equipment of each type to the peak figures indicated by the equipment schedule.
3-4
SHEET 1 of 2
ESTIMATED BY Brown DATE 6/13/95
CHECKED BY Greene DATE 6/23/95
EQUIPMENT ESTIMATE
NMCB_________________________LOCATION Guam YEAR 1995
PROJECT No. 013 PROJECT TITLE CONSTRUCT BLDG 101 DESCRIPTION Site Preparation
Earth Fill 36,000 CD loose measurement required.Haul one way 2-1/2 miles.Use 2-1/2 CD end loader and 10 CD dump trucks.
End loader capacity 100 CD/hour36,000 100 = 360 hours or 45 eight-hour days.
100 10 = 10 trucks loaded per hour.
Average hauling speed estimated at 15 MPH.2 X 2.5 = 5 miles round trip.
515 X 60 = 20 minutes hauling time.
6010 = 6 minutes loading time.
Estimated dumping time 4 minutes.30 minutes total time per truck load.
6030 = Two loads per hour per truck.
10 2 = Five trucks required to keep end loader working at capacity.
100 X 8 = 800 CD hauled per 8-hour day.
Need one bulldozer (can spread 1,400 CD daily).Need one grader to keep haul road in shape.
One tractor and tandem sheepfoot roller (can compact 1,200 CD daily).
One water truck with sprinkler for moisture control.
One rubber-tired wobbly wheel roller on standby for compaction and sealing fill when rain is expected (can be towed byabove bulldozer or tractor).
FIGURE 3-1. Equipment Estimate Sample (Sheet 1 of 2)
3-5
SHEET 2 of 2
ESTIMATED BY Brown DATE 6/13/95
CHECKED BY Greene DATE 6/23/95
EQUIPMENT ESTIMATE
NMCB_________________________LOCATION Guam YEAR 1995
PROJECT No. 013 PROJECT TITLE CONSTRUCT BLDG 101 DESCRIPTION Site Preparation
NOTE: The preceding example is not very efficient , as spreading equipment is not used to full capacity. Suppose that when the workscheduled is prepared, completion of fill will be required in 18 days. Assume that the climate is that 3 days in every 17 working dayswill be lost due to rain. Therefore, 15 working days would be available in an 18-day schedule.
3,600 15 = 2,400 CD must be hauled daily to complete the work on schedule.
2,400 800 = Three times the output of loading and hauling spread shown previously.
Equipment required to load and haul:Three 2-1/2 CD end loadersOne Bulldozer to keep pit in shapeone Grader to keep haul road in shapeFifteen 10-ton trucks hauling (one or two extra trucks should be added to assure that a truck will always be waiting to be
loaded so that end loader will work at full capacity).
2,400 CD will be hauled each day
2,4001,200 = Two tractors and tandem sheepfoot roller for compaction
Two bulldozers to spread earth
2,4001,400 = One water truck with sprinkler
One wobbly-wheel roller (standby for sealing of fill before rains).
NOTE: This is a more efficient operation, because production has been tripled but equipment has not, and total equipment workingat or as close to capacity as can be expected.
FIGURE 3-1. Equipment Estimate Sample (Sheet 2 of 2)
3-6
5. TABLE OF ALLOWANCE. The Naval Mobile Construction Battalion (NMCB) Tableof Allowance (TOA) contains specific information on the quantities and characteristics of theconstruction equipment available for NMCBs. Table 3-1 contains an abbreviated list of suchconstruction equipment.
TABLE 3-1. NMCB TA-01 Construction Equipment Characteristics ______________________________________________________________________________Qty EC Description______________________________________________________________________________16 0355-01 TRK, Pickup, 4X4, 4 Dr, 9200 GVW 4 0360-41 TRK, Util Cargo, 4X4, DED, HMMWV XM998 8 0360-51 TRK, Armament Carrier, 4X4, HMMWV M1043 2 0361-41 TRK, AMB, 2 Litter, 4X4, DED, HMMWV XM103516 0587-51 TRK, Dump, 5T Mil, 6X6, FMTV M109014 0588-51 TRK, Cargo, %T Mil, 6X6, FMTV M108310 0607-51 TRK, Trac, 5T, 6X6, FMTV M1088 4 0645-21 TRK, Trac, 6X6, DED, 600000 GVW 2 0709-51 TRK, Lube, Servicing, 6X6, Auto Trans., FMTV M1092 4 0722-21 TRK, Maint/Util, 4X4, DED, 8500 GVW 2 0730-21 TRK, Wrecker, 25T, 6X6, Commercial, 46000 GVW 2 0746-01 TRK, Truck TNK Fuel, 4X2, DED, 1500 Gal______________________________________________________________________________84 Subtotal______________________________________________________________________________10 0816-11 Semi, Stake, 34X, 34T, 40 FT Mil13 0825-11 Semi, Lowbed, 34X, 35T 5 0829-02 Dolly, TRLR Conv, 9T Commercial 1 0842-01 TRLR, BOLST, Pipe/Pole, 13T payload10 0880-02 TRLR, TNK 400G, Potable water M149A2______________________________________________________________________________39 Subtotal______________________________________________________________________________ 2 1820-00 TRFK, 4k-20k lb CAP, Rough, DED 5 1820-04 TRFK, 4000 lb CAP, Rough, DED 7 1820-12 TRFK, 12000 lb CAP, Rough, DED______________________________________________________________________________14 Subtotal______________________________________________________________________________ 2 2433-01 MXR, CONC, Wheel, MTD, 11 CF, DED 1 2520-12 Distributor Asphalt, TRK MTD, 6X6, 2000 gal 2 2521-05 Distributor Water, TRK MTD, 6X6, 2000 gal 2 2521-22 Distributor Water, Off Hwy, 7000 gal, DED______________________________________________________________________________ 7 Subtotal______________________________________________________________________________
3-7
TABLE 3-1. NMCB TA-01 Construction Equipment Characteristics (Continued) _______________________________________________________________________________Qty EC Description______________________________________________________________________________ 4 3135-02 COMPRES, WHEEL MTD, DED, 250 CFM 1 3165-02 COMPRES, WHEEL MTD, DED, 750 CFM 1 3165-11 COMPRES, WHEEL MTD, DED, 750 CFM 300 PSI 1 3630-32 HAMMER PILE, 1600 FT LBS, W/LEADS 1 3635-01 EXTRACTOR PILE, AIR, 100T LINK PULL 2 3710-11 AUGER, EARTH, TRK MTD, DED, 24 INCH X 10 FT 1 3720-02 DRILL WELL, WATER ROT/PER, 1500 FT, DED ETWD 1 3720-51 DRILL, SUPPORT ULH, DED, 6X6,FRONTV M1086_______________________________________________________________________________12 Subtotal_______________________________________________________________________________ 1 4310-01 DITCHING MACH, LDDR TYPE,DED, CRAWLER MTD 1 4310-02 DITCHING MACH, WHL TYPE, DED, 6 FT DEPTH 2 4350-01 EXCAVATOR, CRWLR MTD, W/BKTS, PAV BRKR 6 4420-21 GRADER, ROAD, MOTORIZED,DED,6X4,OPEN ROPS 4 4530-41 LOADER,SCOOP,FULL-TRKED, 2-1/2 CY W/ROPS 3 4531-10 LOADER,SCP,WHL,2 CY,MP,BKT,BHOE,FRKS,ROPS 3 4531-30 LOADER,SCP,WHL, 2-1/2CY, MP, BKT,
BHOE,FRKS,BOOM,ROPS 2 4615-01 ROLLER, MOTORIZED, COMPACTOR, 9 WHLD 3 4635-20 ROLLER, ROAD, VIBRATORY, 1 DRUM, FRONT, ROPS 6 4750-20 SCRAPER TRACTOR, DED,4X2,14-18 CY, ROPS 2 4830-10 TRACTOR CRAWLER, DED, 105HP, STRGHT BLD, ROPS 3 4850-12 TRACTOR CRWLR, DED, 195 HP, A-BLD, WNCH, CAB 3 4850-21 TRACTOR CRAWLER, DED 195 HP, SEMI-V BLD 1 4875-04 TRC WHL, END, 4X2, 60HP, LDR, ICY, BKT,
BHOE, EC 2 4875-10 TRK WHL, END, 4X2, 60HP, LDR, ICY, BKT,
BHOE, ROP______________________________________________________________________________42 Subtotal______________________________________________________________________________10 5110-22 FLDLT SET, TRLR MTD, DED, 5KW W/4 1KW LUM 2 5121-10 GENERATOR SLT, SKID MTD, DED, 10KW, MRP 803A 4 5121-15 GENERATOR SLT, SKID MTD, DED 15KW, MRP 004A 3 5122-30 GENERATOR SLT, SKID MTD ,DED 30KW, MRP 805A 6 5124-60 GENERATOR SLT, SKID MTD, DED 60KW, MRP 806A 1 5160-01 LUBRICATION/SERVICING CMT, SKID MTD 7 5170-71 WELDER, ARC, WHL MTD, DED, 3-- AMP, TIG 2 5210-11 PUMP, DIAPHRAGM, RECIPROCATING, DED, 100GPM 2 5220-19 PUMP, CENTRIFUGAL, SLTWTR, SKID, GED, 500 GPM 8 5220-21 PUMP, CENTRIFUGAL, TRASH, WHL, GED, 400GPM 1 5220-31 PUMP, CENTRIFUGAL, TRASH, TRLR MTD, 1000 GPM
3-8
TABLE 3-1. NMCB TA-01 Construction Equipment Characteristics (Continued) _______________________________________________________________________________Qty EC Description______________________________________________________________________________ 2 5420-01 SPRAYER, DECONTM, MIL, 50 GPM W/SHOWER, SKID 2 5710-21 SWEEPER, PERM, MAGNET, TOWED, 8 FT, SWATH 4 5900-01 SAW, RADIAL ARM, WOOD, 16 INCH BLADE, DED, GED 1 5910-11 SHOP MACHINE, MOBILE SEMITRLR MTD______________________________________________________________________________30 Subtotal______________________________________________________________________________ 2 8215-01 CRANE, TRUCK MTD, 2 ENG, PRT, 35T 2 8254-25 CRANE, WHL MTD, 4X4, CONTAINER HANDLING______________________________________________________________________________4 Subtotal______________________________________________________________________________263 TOTAL______________________________________________________________________________
a. Functions and Use of Common NMCB Construction Equipment. Thefollowing information about the functions and uses of common construction equipment is basicand not meant to replace the knowledge and skills gained from practical experience. It is offeredto assist planners who are not themselves equipment operators, and to supplement the informationin table 3-1 and the TOA. The following descriptions cover only that equipment listed in theTOA for an NMCB. Planners should recognize that there may be additional (augment) equipmentavailable at a construction site, and that such equipment must be taken into consideration whenmaking job estimates.
(1) Graders are designed for finish grade work but can be used in a variety ofgrading and ditching jobs. Most motor graders are equipped with scarifier teeth for breaking up"hard pan" and asphalt paving.
(2) Loaders have two general classifications: track or crawler tractor mounted;and wheel or pneumatic tire tractor mounted. The primary job of the loader is to load commonearth materials into dump trucks or other earth hauling equipment. Most NCF loaders areequipped with a "4-in-1" bucket which can be used as a loader, scraper, dozer, or clamshell.Loaders come with a variety of attachments, such as rear-mounted backhoe and lifting forksinterchangeable with the front-end loader bucket. The loader is a versatile piece of constructionequipment capable of digging above or below ground level, dozing, and rough grading.
(3) Rollers are classified by the job they are intended to do, and by theirweight. They may be either self-propelled or drawn. Weight varies with make, model, and typeof roller. In order to increase compaction capabilities, vibratory rollers have been developed inboth the towed and self-propelled types. Some later model rollers have articulated-type steering.The basic types and their purposes are as follows:
3-9
Type Roller Purpose______________________________________________________________________________
Sheep foot Tamp and compact fill materialGrid Break and crush rocks and pavementThree wheel Breakdown and roll subsurfaceTandem Finish roll asphalt pavingRubber tire Knead action subsurface compactionVibratory Deeper penetration and vibration force
______________________________________________________________________________
(4) Scrapers have two general classifications: drawn or towed; and motorizedor self-propelled. Scrapers towed by track-laying tractors have self-loading capabilities beyondthose of motorized scrapers, but are restricted in their efficient hauling distance, ranging from300 to 1,500 feet. The struck capacity for scrapers most frequently used by the Seabees rangesfrom 14 to 18 cubic yards. Generally, scrapers are used where large volumes of material are tobe hauled in "cut and fill" operations.
(5) Tractors have two general classifications used in earth moving: wheel orpneumatic tire tractors; and track or crawler types. Both types are used to pull scrapers, rollers,and other earth moving or compacting equipment, and may be fitted with a dozer blade, loader,backhoe, and a variety of other attachments.
(6) Cranes have three general types of land cranes, plus floating or barge-mounted cranes. The three types of land cranes are: track mounted or crawler cranes; truckmounted; and self-propelled rubber tired (single engine), sometimes called "maxi-mount."Capacities of cranes are usually rated in two ways: safe-load lifting capacity; and cubic yardsstruck bucket capacity. There is a variety of attachments that is standard with the basic cranemachine. The following is a list of crane attachments and their characteristics.______________________________________________________________________________
Attachment Characteristics ______________________________________________________________________________Lattice-type Boom Hook block for general lifting jobs.
Clamshell bucket for vertical digging below ground level; ideal fordigging manholes, charging aggregate hoppers, where vertical height anddepth is needed.
Dragline for below ground level digging of trenches or culverts; wellsuited for bank sloping, with horizontal digging action as the bucket isdrawn toward the machine.
Pile driver leads.Orange peel for handling large boulders.Headache ball for demolition work.Magnet.
Assorted specialized hooks and lifting devices.
3-10
______________________________________________________________________________Attachment Characteristics
______________________________________________________________________________Backhoe, or Pull Shovel Used for below ground-level digging. The digging action is similar to a dragline in
that the bucket is drawn toward the machine.
Positive digging action due to its rigid construction, which makes it ideally suitedto work in hard material. It is limited in reach, however.
Not well suited to bank sloping.
(7) Multi-purpose excavator, sometimes referred to as a "grade all," is an all-hydraulic-control machine with a pivoting telescoping arm or boom which comes with a varietyof quick change attachments for a large number of jobs. It is ideal for trenching, diggingfootings, digging manholes, and bank sloping.
6. MATERIAL WEIGHTS AND PERCENT OF SWELL. Data that pertain to the weightand percentage of swelling of various construction materials are presented in chapter 4, table 4-18. These data are helpful to the estimator to prepare quantity estimates.
4-1
CHAPTER 4. LABOR ESTIMATES
1. TYPES OF LABOR ESTIMATES. There are two types of labor estimates:preliminary manpower estimates, and detailed manpower estimates.
a. Preliminary manpower estimates are used to establish costs for budget purposesand to project manpower requirements for succeeding projects and deployments. The estimatesare prepared from limited information: general descriptions or preliminary plans andspecifications that contain little or no detailed information; for example, on the basis of area,length, or other suitable measurement. In some cases, a comparison may be made with similarfacilities of the same basic design, size, and type of construction. A good preliminary estimateshould vary less than 15 percent from the detailed estimate.
The NAVFAC P-437, Facilities Planning Guide, Volume 1(drawings), and Volume 2(materials list) is an excellent source for preliminary estimates which can be used to find estimatesfor a wide range of facilities and assemblies commonly constructed. The NAVFAC P-437 notonly gives the man-hours required, but also gives a breakdown of the construction effort by rating(BU, CE, UT, and so forth), as well as construction duration estimates.
b. Detailed manpower estimates are used to determine the manpower requirementsfor the construction of a given project and the local direct labor requirements of a deployment.Detailed estimates are prepared using the individual activity quantities taken from the activitywork sheet. Then, selecting from the appropriate table the man-hours per unit figure, andmultiplying by the quantity, the total man-hours required is obtained. When the activity estimatesare prepared in the format as discussed in chapter 2, a copy of the estimate may be used as amanpower estimate work sheet by adding columns with the headings of Activity Quantity, Man-Hours/Unit, and Man-Days Required. Work sheets, whether prepared using the Activity worksheet, or another format, should be prepared in sufficient detail to provide the degree of progresscontrol desired. For example, if the work sheets show the following:
Work Sheet
Man-Hours TotalDescription Quantity Per Unit Man-Days
Exterior spray 6,000SF .007mhrs/SF 5.25 mdspainting, flat metal
Exterior brush 10,000 SF .012 mhrs/SF 15.00 mdspainting, wood siding
Exterior roller 100,000 SF .01 mhrs/SF 125.00 mdspainting, masonry
TOTAL 116,00 SF 145.25 mds
4-2
If the control is to be exercised only on exterior painting without regard to detail, the ManpowerEstimate would show the following on the work sheet.
WORK SHEET
Man-Hours TotalDescription Quantity Per Unit Man-Days
Exterior Painting 116,000 SF 0.01 mhrs/SF 145 mds
2. CHECKLISTS. Manpower estimates should be checked against the activity estimate toassure that no activities have been omitted. The tables included in the chapters concerned withmanpower estimates may serve as a checklist for omissions. In addition, a work element (oractivity) checklist is included as appendix A, and an equipment and tool checklist is included asappendix B.
3. FACTORS AFFECTING PRODUCTION. In preparing manpower estimates variousfactors which affect the amount of labor required to construct a project must be weighed andconsidered. These factors are: weather conditions during the construction period; the skill andexperience of the men who will perform the work; the time allotted for completion of the job;the size of the crew to be used; the accessibility of the site; and the types of material andequipment to be used. The following guidance is presented to aid the estimator in evaluating andapplying these factors to his estimates.
a. Workload. The time allotted for construction of the project has a definite bearingon the number of workers assigned to do the work. Rush jobs may require a crew to work longhours and 7 days a week. A worker's production per hour decreases sharply under theseconditions. Sometimes it is better to increase the number of workers in a crew or work severalcrafts at the same time in one location in order to complete a job quickly. When work area iscrowded, workers are likely to get into each other's way, or distract others in the area. Theresults are reduction in efficiency so that more man-days are being used to accomplish the sameamount of work. The size of the crew can affect production in another way. Crews are madeup of workers with the various skills required to do a certain job and are assigned to jobs as acrew. They vary in size. When a crew is assigned to a job which will not take quite all day,there is tendency to slow down and make the work last out the day.
For example, electricians and utilities men have to work at the same time in the same area,working 12-14 hour days, the efficiency factor can be as low as .30; on the other extreme, ifeach craft can work independently in different areas of the project, then the efficiency factor canbe as high as .85.
b. Site Area. The space for equipment maneuverability, storage of materials, and joblayout, have significant impact on the productivity of the crew. Site accessibility can affect labor
4-3
requirements for a project. A hard-to-reach site may cause irregular delivery of materials andtime consuming delays, which use man-hours without producing results. These factors must beconsidered when estimating manpower requirements for a project. Conditions may vary, crampedworking area, no material storage, may reduce productivity to .25 -.30 efficiency. An exampleof ideal working conditions, large work area, no restrictions on use or equipmentmaneuverability, all materials stored at the site with easy access, will rate high .80's asproductivity efficiency in that area.
c. Labor. The skill and experience of the workers who are assigned to the workshould be considered when deciding the man-hour range to use. The production rate ofexperienced workers is better than that of a workers with little or no experience. If a crewconsists of a few experienced workers and many inexperienced workers, the experience workerswill use part of their time instructing and training the inexperienced workers. If a deploymentconsists of essentially the same type of construction on all its projects, inexperienced workers willincrease their skill before the deployment is completed. Jobs performed towards the end of thedeployment, after many months of similar work are done quicker, and with less effort. Forexample, a person with no training or experience will rate .25 -.30, "A" school graduate mayraise factor to .35 -.40, a 3rd class petty officer will average .50 -.65, a journeyman with longexperience at task ma rate .80 -.85 in efficiency.
The physical abilities of a person dictates how much can be accomplished in a given timeperiod. Someone with limited physical power to lift or with no endurance will slow downprogress of the project significantly, compared to a person with great physical power, agility andendurance. Efficiency will vary from .25 -.30 for weak to .65 -.75 for someone who is strong.
General health will affect performance of the crew; the "flu season" will slow down evenstrongest person. High sick call may rate .25 -.30 and sporadic sick call will rate .70 -.80 inefficiency.
The morale of the crew will dictate how quickly the job will progress. Hardships ingetting to and from the job, or meals which are delayed or serve cold, extended working hours,and poor living conditions tend to lower morale and reduce production.
d. Supervision. The skill and experience of the crew leader has a definitive bearingon how the crew performs. A 3rd class petty officer with little training and experience mayachieve .30 -.40 efficiency factor; a 2nd class petty officer with repetitive projects, and leadershiptraining will perform an average range, for the Seabees, of .60 -.70; an experienced 1st classpetty officer may have .70 -.85 efficiency rating.
e. Job Conditions. Conditions that a worker faces on the job effects productivity.Low quality work requirements such as rough surfaces, inexact cuts, where visibility is not
4-4
important may have a .70 -.75 efficiency rating. Median quality requirements such as temporaryconstruction may have an average efficiency rating. High visibility projects where highest qualityand workmanship are required may have an efficiency rating of .25 -.30. The types of materialused may slow down job progress significantly. Heavy wet clay is much more difficult toexcavate than sandy loam or sand. Bulky or heavy materials will require more time andequipment than light, prepackaged, easy to handle materials. The efficiency factor may rangefrom .25 -.35 for heavy clays to .75 -.80 for pelletized tiles. Time allocated for operations willgive .30 -.40 for "short fuse" or short duration projects to .65 -.80 for projects with adequatetime. Insect annoyance has to be taken under consideration. A site with great number ofmosquitos, gnats, or other insects will have a .30 -.40 efficiency factor, where a site with noinsects may rate .65 -.80.
f. Weather conditions. Weather conditions have an effect on the number of man-hours required to do a job. Cold, damp climates, as well as hot, humid climates, reduce aworker's daily production and affect the output of construction equipment. Although time lostdue to rain is not normally charged against a project, rain in the midst of a construction operationslows production and sometimes causes additional work which increases the number of man-hoursrequired to repair damages, and to remove water from work areas before construction canresume.
In colder climates it is usually necessary to provide heat and protection for some partsof a project. Allowances must be made in the estimate for weather conditions either by selectinga man-hours per unit, which will provide some labor for these possibilities, or by directly addingman-hours to provide for them. Appendix E lists the average monthly temperature, averagemonthly rainfall, and average monthly days of rain for the various Seabee deployment locations.This table will assist in selecting a more accurate percentage for weather conditions. As anexample, a summer deployment to Guam, with temperatures in upper 80's, high humidity, andfrequent intermittent rain rates .25 -.35 in efficiency. A home port project in Port Hueneme inlate August with pleasant weather, low humidity, no rain fall, an ideal construction weather willrate .65 -.75 in efficiency. A project on Adak during winter months will be affected significantlyby cold winds, snow and rain and miserable weather. This will slow the project to .25 -.30efficiency rating.
g. Equipment. The type of equipment available has considerable effect on theamount of labor required to perform a certain task. It is, therefore, necessary for the estimatorto know what equipment will be used on a project before he can make an accurate estimate ofmanpower requirements. For instance, he needs to know whether soil is to be hauled in trucksor scrapers and the equipment size (it will take twice as many drivers and trucks if 5 cubic yardtrucks are used instead of 10 cubic yard trucks). The estimator needs to know if concrete is tobe placed by cranes and concrete buckets or with wheelbarrows, and if piles are to be driven witha diesel hammer or a drop hammer. The conditions of the equipment will dictate how often apiece has to go for repairs. Frequent breakdowns and maintenance requirements will haveefficiency as low as .30 -.40 for a given task to high .60 -.75 for a new piece that stays on thejob site and is always operational and requires minimal maintenance.
4-5
h. Tactics and Logistics. Location of a job site will have tremendous impact on theprogress of the project; remote location, slow supply delivery, frequent tactical delays will rate. 25 -.35 in efficiency factor. Project near the main camp, prompt deliveries, no tactical delaywill rate .70 -.80 in efficiency factor. As an examples, a DFT project in South America, distantfrom a supply point, with special ordering requirements will rate .25; a project nearCampMitchell, where there are no problems with supply and delivery will rate .65; and a homeport project in Gulfport where materials can be delivered at a moment’s notice will rate .75 -.80in efficiency.
4. PRODUCTION EFFICIENCY GUIDE CHART AND GRAPH. The chart (table 4-1)lists eight production elements that directly affect production. Each element is subdivided intothree areas for evaluation, each of which contains two or more foreseen conditions from whichto select as applicable to the job in question. The estimator evaluates each production elementat some specific percentage between .25 and 1.00, according to the estimator's analysis of theforeseen conditions. The average of the eight evaluations is the overall production efficiencypercentage. The percentage is then converted to a delay factor by using the graph (figure 4-1),or by dividing the average Seabee production (67 percent) by the average of the eight productionelements. It is strongly recommended that field or project supervisors, once on site, reevaluatethe various production elements and make the necessary adjustment to man-day figures, based onthe actual conditions as found at the job site prior to the 45-day review. It is very easy to overrate the capabilities of the crew, and other factors. This will give a higher than actualefficiency factor which, in turn, will give less man-days than needed to complete the project.
The estimate of average Seabee production in this manual falls at 67 percent on the bottomof the graph (figure 4-1), which in turn will be a delay factor of 1.00 on the right. A delay factorof 0.67 represents peak production. The delay factor is used only to determine man-dayestimates. Use the formula that follows to determine a man-day estimate.
Man-Day Estimate: MD = (QTY / UNIT SIZE) x (MHRS / UNIT) / 8 x DF MD = Man-Day EstimateQTY = Material quantity from material take off (MTO)UNIT SIZE = Obtained from labor estimating tablesMHRS/UNIT = Obtained from labor estimating tables8 = 8 hours per one man-dayDF = Delay Factor obtained from production efficiency chart
a. How to Use the Chart and Graph. Assume that from the tables in this handbookyou extract an estimate of 6 man-hours for a given unit of a work element. To adjust this figureto the conditions evaluated on your job, assume that the average of foreseen conditions rated byyou is 87 percent. The corresponding delay factor read off figure 4-1 is 0.80 or .67 / .87 = .77.The adjusted man-hour estimate is found by multiplying this factor by the man-hours from theestimating tables, shown in the computation: 6MHRS x 0.80MHRS = 4.8MHRS or 6MHRS x.77 = 4.6MHRS
4-6
TABLE 4-1. Production Efficiency Guide Chart
LOW PRODUCTION AVERAGE PRODUCTION HIGH PRODUCTION
PERCENTAGE 25 35 45 55 65 75 85 95
1. WORKLOAD Construction req't high Construction req't avg. Construction req't lowMisc. overhead high Misc. overhead avg. Misc. overhead low
2. SITE AREA Cramped work area Work area limited Large work areaPoor laydown/access Avg. laydown/access Good laydown/access
3. LABOR Poorly trained/motivated or inexperienced Adequately trained/motivated crew Highly trained/motivated crew
4. SUPERVISION Poorly trained/motivated or inexperienced Adequately trained/motivated/experienced Highly trained/motivated/experienced
5. JOB CONDITION High quality work req'd/short fuse Avg. quality work req'd/adequate time Rough/unfinished work req'd/wellplanned
6. WEATHER Abnormal heat, rain, cold Moderate rain, heat, cold Favorable rain, heat, cold
7. EQUIPMENT Poor cond., maint., repair, application Fair cond., maint., repair, application Good cond., maint., repair, application
8. TACTICAL/LOGISTICAL Slow supply, frequent tactical delays Normal supply, few tactical delays Good supply, no tactical delays
Table Notes: 1. The weights of the elements can be adjusted if known facts so indicate.
2. Rainfall is normally treated separately in the area of calendar day scheduling.Predictions of lost construction days are based on geographic rainfall charts. Typhoon andhurricane seasons can cause considerable lost time in securing job sites for alerts and warnings,even if work areas are not directly in the path of the storm.
3. The tactical delay area of consideration should include: night travelrestrictions; mine sweeps on roads into the work area; preparation of zig-zag trenches orindividual protective measure; sabotage of equipment or materials left on the job site; and anyadditional security requirements which detract from the assigned work force.
4. The continual theft of tools and materials can affect production and is verycommon in some areas of the world. This condition requires abnormal controls and security,which in turn slows production.
5. The man-hour estimates contained in this manual are based on the averageSeabee Production Efficiency which is 67 percent.
4-7
FIGURE 4-1. Production Efficiency Graph
5. LABOR ESTIMATING TABLES. The man-hour labor estimating tables contained inthis chapter are arranged and grouped together into the 17 major divisions of work. This is thesame system used in the preparation of government construction specifications established by theConstruction Specifications Institute (CSI). The 17 major divisions of work are presented in thefollowing list, together with the labor estimating tables associated with that division.
SEVENTEEN MAJOR DIVISIONS OF WORK
Divisions Tables Divisions Tables
1. GENERAL 4-2 through 4-5 9. FINISHES 4-102 through 4-117
2. SITEWORK 4-6 through 4-38 10. SPECIALTIES 4-118 through 4-120
3. CONCRETE 4-39 through 4-55 11. Architectural Equipment Not used
4. MASONRY 4-56 through 4-63 12. Furnishings Not used
5. METAL 4-64 through 4-79 13. Special Construction (ABFC ) Not used
6. CARPENTRY 4-80 through 4-93 14. Conveying System Not used
7. MOISTURE PROTECTION 4-94 through 4-98 15.MECHANICAL 4-121 through 4-136
8. DOORS, WINDOWS, GLASS 4-99 through 4-101 16.ELECTRICAL 4-137 through 4-153
17. EXPEDITIONARY STRUCTURES 4 - 154 through 4 - 155
a. How to Use the Labor Estimating Tables. The activities in the various laborestimating tables are divided into units which are always ONE not measurement commonlyassociated with each craft and material take-off quantities. There is only one amount of man-hours effort per unit of work. This number represents normal Seabee production under averageconditions. As used here, one man-day equals eight man-hours of direct labor. Man-day figuresdo not include overhead items such as dental or personnel visits, transportation to and from thejob site, or inclement weather.
4-8
No two jobs will be exactly alike and have exactly the same conditions; therefore, the estimator mustexercise some judgment about the project that is being planned. The production efficiency guide andgraph (table 4-1, figure 4-1) are provided to assist the estimator to weigh the many factors thatcontribute to varying production, and eventual completion of a project. The estimator can thentranslate what is known, and can predict a more accurate quantity from the average figures given onthe labor estimating tables.
b. Efficiency Factor. There are three types of efficiency factors that impact on manpowerresources. The definitions of these three types should assist the estimator to decide when to apply eachtowards the manpower availability equations.
(1) Direct Labor Efficiency factor is used to determine how much construction typeproduction a battalion main body or detachment is achieving. It is easily determined from the SituationReport (SITREP). The overall battalion goal is 30 percent while main body averages are 20 percent.The formula is the fraction (written as percent) of actual direct labor divided by the total strength ofthe battalion. It is used where actual direct labor is the total labor charged to the project tasking, andis accounted for by the timekeepers at each job site. The total strength includes every enlisted personin the battalion, both Occupational Field 13 (OF-13) and non OF-13.
(2) Production Efficiency factor is used to estimate the amount of man-daysnecessary to complete a specific project. The average Seabee production is 67 percent (table 4-1).The efficiency is impacted by eight production elements (workload, site area, labor, supervision, jobconditions, weather, equipment, tactical and logistical) at each job site.
(3) Availability factor (percentage) determines how much of the planned directlabor is available. Each main body and detachment side has an historical availability factor that canbe used to determine how much manpower is available during a deployment. Such items as leave andliberty, battalion inspections, collateral duties, all impact on how much time the direct labor plannedbecomes actual. The average availability factor ranges from 60 percent to 90 percent and depends onthe deployment site. Thus, the formula is: Direct Labor Planned x Availability Factor = Direct LaborActual. This factor is used in the Man-Day Capability equation shown below.
Man-Day Capability: MC =DL x AF x WD x ME
MC = Man-Day Capability, Man-Day Availability or Tasked Man-DaysDL = Planned Direct LaborAF = Availability FactorWD = Available Workdays, Total Deployment Days less Sundays,
holidays, turnover, training and off Saturdays. (Obtained fromthe deployment calender.)
ME = Man-Day Equivalent, Planned work hours per day divided by8 hours (one man-day). Example: a 9-hour workday can beshown 9/8 or 1.125
4-9
An example of the use of these factors to staff a detachment is shown below.
GIVEN: Tasking (MC) = 3,000 Man-DaysWork Days (WD) = 120 daysMan-Day Equivalent (ME) = 1.125 or 9/8Availability Factor (AF) = .80 or 80 percent
FIND: Size of Detachment necessary to achieve tasking.
SOLUTION: MC = DL x AF x WD x ME3000 = DL x .80 x 120 x 1.1253000 = DL x 1083000 = DL x 108 108 108 DL = 28 Seabees
Note: The planned direct labor is 28 Seabees. Actual direct labor equals 28 x .8 or22.4 Seabees. This means that 22.4 Saebees will be on the job at any giventime.
If the Detachment received 10 Seabees for overhead or indirect labor, such as Admin Personnel,Central Tool Room (CTR), Material Liaison Office (MLO), Construction Mechanics (CM), etc., thetotal strength becomes 28 + 10 = 38 Seabees. The percent of actual direct labor for the Detachmentwould be 22.4/38 = 58.9 or 59 percent.
This same formula can be used by the crewleader (estimator) to determine duration or crew size fora given activity by making the following substitution in the basic equation:
MC = MD (Man-Day Estimates)DL = CS (Crew Size)WD = DUR (Duration)
MD = CS x AF x DUR x ME
Solving for Duration the equation becomes:DUR = MD /(CS x AF x ME)
Solving for Crew Size the equation becomes:CS = MD/(DUR x AF x ME)
4-10
This page is blank
4-11
DIVISION 1. GENERALPage
A. PLANT OPERATIONTable 4-2 Asphalt Plant Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-11Table 4-3 Rock Crushing Plant Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-11
B. GENERAL SUPPORT ITEMSTable 4-4 Scaffolding, Runways, and Ramps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-12Table 4-5 Temporary Construction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-12
4-12
This page is blank
4-13
TABLE 4-2. Asphalt Plant Operation
Work Element Description Unit Man-Hours Per Unit
Setup and Dismantle Plant Each 120 (1155)
Operation of Asphalt Plant TN 0.08 (1156)
Haul Asphalt to Job TN / MI 0.048 (1157)
SUGGESTED CREW SIZE:Setup and Dismantle Plant: five EOs, one CE, one SW, one CMAsphalt Plant Operation: five EOsHauling Asphalt to Job Site: EOs required depend on scop of jobMaintenance (support): one CE, one CM, two EOs(one plant operator, one ground man, one loader operator)
NOTES: 1. Figures are based on drum mix plant, 70 ton per hour.2. Site preparation and concrete curing time not included in table.
TABLE 4-3. Rock Crushing Plant Operation
Work Element Description Unit Man-Hours Per Unit
Setup and Dismantle Each 320 (1158)
Operate Crushing Plant CD 0.16 (1159)
Stockpile Crushed Material CD 0.0 24 (1160)
Haul Crushed Material to Job CD 0.048 (1161)
SUGGESTED CREW SIZE:Setup and Dismantle Plant: seven EOs, one SW, one CE, one CMOperate Crushing Plant: two EOsStockpile Crushed Material: four EOsMaintenance (support): one SW, one CE, one CM
NOTE: 1. The production figure is based upon 75 TPH plant operating at 50 percent of rated capacity crushinggranite at 3,000 LB per cubic yard. For plants of other sizes use 50 percent of rated capacity and thesize of your crew for calculations.
2. Production figures may have to be adjusted in accordance with the type of material being processed,and with other varying circumstances. For example: Coral weights (approximately 2,000 LB per loosecubic yard.
4-14
TABLE 4-4. Scaffolding, Runways, and Ramps
Work Element Description Unit Man-Hours Per Unit
Erect and Dismantle Tubular SF of Wall Surface 0.04 (1164)Scaffold (including Planks andLeveling)
Construct Runways and Ramps SF 0.064 (1162)
Place and Remove (runways FT 0.16 (1163)and ramps)
SUGGESTED CREW SIZE:Scaffolding Erection: three to four BUs, increase crew size for multiple tiers.
NOTE: 1. The first tier requires more time due to leveling and alignment procedures.
TABLE 4-5. Temporary Construction
Work Element Description Unit Man-Hours Per Unit
Barricades (Wood Frame and FT (4' High) 0.64 (1165)Plywood) Fabricate and Erect FT (8' High) 0.75 (1166)4' High, 8' High
Rubbish chute Prefabricated 36 FT 0.5 (1167)Inches Diameter
SUGGESTED CREW SIZE:Two to four non-skilled
NOTE: 1. For temporary roads and fencing refer to Division 2; for temporary water service refer to Division15; for temporary lighting and electrical service refer to Division 16.
4-15
DIVISION 2. SITE WORK
Page
A. CLEARINGTable 4-6 Acreage and Areas . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-15Table 4-7 Clearing, Stripping, and Grubbing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-16Table 4-8 Demolition and Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-17
B. EXCAVATIONTable 4-9 General Excavation Factors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-18Table 4-10 Front End Loaders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-18Table 4-11 Bulldozer Production . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-19Table 4-12 Clamshell . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-19Table 4-13 Draglines . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-20
C. TRENCHINGTable 4-14 Trench Excavation Factors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-20Table 4-15 Power Excavators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-21Table 4-16 Trencher/Ditchers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-21Table 4-17 Sheeting and Shoring Excavations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-22
D. EARTHMOVINGTable 4-18 Material Weights and Swell Factors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-23Table 4-19 Dump Trucks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-24Table 4-20 Wheel Tractor Scrapers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-24
Continued next page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4-16
DIVISION 2. SITE WORK (Continued)Page
E. GRADINGTable 4-21 Graders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-25
F. COMPACTIONTable 4-22 Compaction Factors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-25Table 4-23 Rollers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-26
G. ASPHALTTable 4-24 Seal Coats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-26Table 4-25 Bituminous Paving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-27
H. BLASTING AND QUARRINGTable 4-26 Rock Drilling and Blasting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-27
I. HAND SITE WORKTable 4-27 Hand Excavation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-28
J. MISCELLANEOUS SITE WORKTable 4-28 Erosion Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-28Table 4-29 Landscaping . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-29Table 4-30 Fencing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-29Table 4-31 Concrete Culvert Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-30Table 4-32 Galvanized Culvert Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-30
K. WATERFRONT CONSTRUCTIONTable 4-33 Piledriving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-31Table 4-34 Miscellaneous Pier Hardware . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-31Table 4-35 Wood Pile Dolphins . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-32Table 4-36 Pier Framing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-32Table 4-37 Pile Bracing and Capping . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-32Table 4-38 Pile Extraction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-33
4-17
TABLE 4-6. Acreage and Areas
Square Tracts of Land
Acres Length of One Side of Square Area SFTrack, FT.
1/10 66.0 4,356 1/8 73.8 5,445 1/6 85.2 7,260 1/4 104.4 10,890 1/3 120.5 14,520 ½ 147.6 21,780
3/4 180.8 32,6701 208.7 43,560
1-1/2 255.6 63,3402 295.2 87,120
2-1/2 330.0 108,9003 361.5 130,6805 466.7 217,800
4-18
TABLE 4-7. Clearing Striping and Grubbing
Work Element Description Unit Per Bulldozer BulldozerHour Size Medium Size Large
Light Clearing: Vegetation, Brush, Saplings SY 0.0012 (1201) 0.0006 (1202)
Moderate Clearing: Vegetation, Thick Brush, SY 0.0024 (1203) 0.0021 (1204)Saplings
Stripping Top Soil: Pile on Site CD 0.0526 (1205) 0.027 (1206)
Work Element Description Unit Man-HoursPer Unit
Trees w/stumps 6 - 12" dia. Fell and Cut for Loading EA 4.00 (1207)
Trees w/stumps 13-18" dia. Fell and Cut for Loading EA 12.00 (1208)
Trees w/stumps 19-24" dia. Fell and Cut for Loading EA 18.00 (1209)
Stump Removal w/Bulldozer EA 1.6 (1210)
Work Element Description Unit Man-HoursPer Unit
Survey, Topographical (level area) (hilly area) SY 0.003 (1211)
SY 0.012 (1212)
Stake Out Clearing Limits(Roads/Runways) FT 0.005 (1213)
Layout Baseline with Offset Hubs at 100-Foot Intervals(level area) FT 0.0051 (1214)(hilly area) FT 0.0078 (1215)
Set Blue Top at 25-FT Interval FT 0.0091 (1216)
Layout Bounds (Building) EA 4.5 (1217)
Layout and Grade Pipe/Culvert EA 4.5 (1218)
SUGGESTED CREW SIZE:Two to three EOsTwo to four non-skilled
4-19
TABLE 4-8. Demolition and Removal
Work Element Description Unit Man-HoursPer Unit
Concrete Foundations CD 5.0 (1068)Concrete Walls CD 6.0 (1069)Concrete Slabs on Grade. No Reinforcing CD 4.0 (1070)Concrete Slabs on Grade w/Wire Mesh Reinforcing CD 4.0 (1071)Concrete Slabs on Grade w/Rebar and Mesh Reinforcing CD 6.0 (1072)
Ceilings, Sheetrock SF 0.024 (1073)Ceilings, Suspended Acoustic SF 0.024 (1074)
Doors and Frames, 3' x 7' Wood Each 2.0 (1075)Doors and Frames, 3' x 7' Steel Each 2.0 (1076)
Flooring, Ceramic or Quarry Tile SF 0.05 (1077)Flooring, Resilient Tile SF 0.03 (1078)Flooring, Wood Floor Finish SF 0.06 (1079)Flooring, Wood Subfloor SF 0.03 (1080)
Framing, Steel Ton 6.8 (1081)Framing, Wood BF 0.016 (1082)
Wallboard, Gypsum SF 0.03 (1083)Wallboard, Plywood SF 0.03 (1084)
Roofing, Corrugated SF 0.03 (1085)Roofing, Buildup 5 Ply SF 0.03 (1086)
Windows, Metal SF 0.096 (1087)Windows, Wood SF 0.1 (1088)
Asphaltic Concrete SY 0.053 (1089)
Rubbish disposal up to 5 miles CD 1.5 (1090)
SUGGESTED CREW SIZE: Minimum crew sizes for various operations will be dictated by safetyand weight, or bulk of materials handled.
NOTE: 1. Work includes removal of item and stacking or piling on site for removal at ground level.
2. Second floor or upper story work includes dumping into rubbish chutes.
3. Concrete demolition is figured on using pneumatic tools with average crew of two tool operators andthree to five laborers.
4. No allowance for salvage of materials (cleaning, pulling nails) is included in this table.
4-20
TABLE 4-9. General Excavation Factors
Depth in Inches CD to be Removed Depth in Feet CD to be Removedor Feet per SF of Area per SF of Area
2.0 IN 0.006 4.5 0.167 4.0 IN 0.012 5.0 0.185 6.0 IN. 0.018 5.5 0.204 8.0 IN 0.025 6.0 0.22210.0 IN 0.031 6.5 0.241 1.0 FT 0.037 7.0 0.259 1.5 FT 0.056 7.5 0.278 2.0 FT 0.074 8.0 0.296 2.5 FT 0.093 8.5 0.314 3.0 FT 0.111 9.0 0.332 3.5 FT 0.130 9.5 0.350 4.0 FT 0.148 10.0 0.369
NOTES: 1. Example: Assume that excavation is 24' x 30' and 6' deep (24 x 30 = 720).
In the table, the 6 FT depth has a factor of 0.222 (the number of CD in an excavation 1SF and 6 FTdeep). Therefore: 720 x 0.222 = 159.84 CD.
TABLE 4-10. Front End Loaders Production
Excavation From Pit to Truck/Pile, Hours per Lose Cubic Yard
Bucket Size Haul Distance (Feet)
CD 50' 100' 150' 200'
1.25 0.0256 (1221) 0.0357 (1222) 0.0476 (1223) 0.0588 (1224)
2.5 0.0081 (1225) 0.0109 (1226) 0.0133 (1227) 0.0161 (1228)
4.0 0.0047 (1229) 0.0062 (1230) 0.0075 (1231) 0.0091 (1232)
NOTES: 1. Figures are in loose CD. Use table 4-18 to find the amount of bank CD (in place) removed. Example: 2-1/2 CD loader at 50' haul = 1/0.0081=124 loose CD in one hour. 124 CD x
swell factor for earth, loam, dry = 124 x .81 = 100 bank CD in one hour.
4-21
TABLE 4-11. Bulldozer Production
Loose Cubic Yardage Production Hours Per Loose Cubic Yard Based on 50-Minute Hour
Haul Distance
Dozer Size 50 FT 100 FT 150 FT 200 FT 300 FT 400 FT
Large 0.0023 0.0035 0.0048 0.0059 0.008 0.0105(D-8) (1252) (1253) (1254) (1255) (1256) (1257)
Medium 0.0027 0.0049 0.0065 0.01 0.0135 0.0182(D-7/FD20) (1258) (1259) (1260) (1261) (1262) (1263)
Small 0.0095 0.0154 0.0217 0.0294 0.0455 ----(D-5/150) (1264) (1265) (1266) (1267) (1268)
NOTES: 1. Figures are in loose CD. Use table 4-18 to find the amount of bank CD (in place).
2. Production is based on "slot dozing." If work is done without slots, use .75 multiplier
TABLE 4-12. Clamshell Production
Clamshell Production - 90 Degree SwingHour Per Loose Cubic Yard (50-Minute Hour)
Type of Work 0.75 CD 1.50 CD 2.50 CD
Loose Sand/Gravel 0.025 (1272) 0.0143 (1273) 0.0095 (1274)
Pit Excavation 0.0294 (1275) 0.0167 (1276) 0.0111 (1277)
SUGGESTED CREW SIZE: Two EOs minimum
NOTE: 1. Figures are based on loose CD. Use table 4-18 to find the amount of bank CD (in-place).
2. Boom swing is for 90 degrees.
4-22
TABLE 4-13. Draglines Production
Dragline Production - 90 Degree Swing Hour per Bank Cubic Yard (50-Minute Hour)
Bucket Size OptimumDigging Depths
Class of material
Sand/Gravel Common Earth Dense Clay
0.75 CD 6 . 00 FT 0.0143 (1282) 0.0147 (1285) 0.02 (1288)
1.50 CD 7 . 33 FT 0.0086 (1283) 0.0095 (1286) 0.0112 (1289)
2.50 CD 8 . 50 FT 0.0061 (1284) 0.00687 (1287) 0.0079 (1290)
SUGGESTED CREW SIZE: Two EOs minimum.
NOTE: 1. Figures are in bank CD. Use table 4-18 to find loose CD.
TABLE 4-14. Trench Excavation Factors
Trench Depth(Inches)
Trench Width (inches)
12 18 24 30 36 42 48
Content of Trench, CD, per foot of length
6 0.019 0.028 0.037 0.046 0.056 0.066 0.07412 0.037 0.560 0.074 0.093 0.111 0.130 0.14818 0.056 0.083 0.111 0.139 0.167 0.194 0.22324 0.074 0.111 0.148 0.185 0.222 0.260 0.29630 0.093 0.138 0.185 0.232 0.278 0.324 0.37036 0.111 0.166 0.222 0.278 0.333 0.389 0.44542 0.130 0.194 0.259 0.324 0.389 0.454 0.52048 0.148 0.222 0.296 0.370 0.445 0.520 0.59254 0.167 0.250 0.333 0.416 0.500 0.584 0.66760 0.186 0.278 0.370 0.463 0.555 0.649 0.741
4-23
TABLE 4-15. Power Excavators Production
Power Excavators ProductionHour per Bank Cubic Yard (50-Minute Hour)
Equipment Type Bucket Size Hour/Bank CD
Tractor Mtd. Backhoes 3/8 CD 0.1 (1302)
Gradalls 30" w/ ½ CD 0.0588 (1304)
Excavator Hyd. Hoes 3/4 CD 0.025 (1306)
½ CD 0.0769 (1303)
48" w/ 1 CD 0.0294 (1305)
1 CD 0.0182 (1307)1-1/2 CD 0.0139 (1308)
SUGGESTED CREW SIZE: Two EOs
NOTE: 1. Figures are in bank CD. Use table 4-18 for loose CD.
TABLE 4-16. Trencher/Ditchers Production
Trencher ProductionHour per Bank Cubic Yard
Equipment Type and Size Width (Inches) Hour/Bank Cubic Yard
Ladder Type 6 0.0833 (1322)Ladder Type 24 0.01 (1323)
Wheel Type 12 0.0125 (1324)Wheel Type 24 0.0047 (1325)
NOTE: 1. Use table 4-18 to figure loose CD.
4-24
TABLE 4-17. Sheeting and Shoring Excavations
Work Element Description Unit Man-Hours per Unit
Installation and Removal of SF of Bank Surface 0.16Solid 2-inch Sheeting for (1332)Trenches 5 FT to 10 FT Deepand 42 IN to 12 FT Wide.
SUGGESTED CREW SIZE: Four EOs. Two cribbing and two helpers.
NOTES: 1. Work for typical unstable soil includes: Solid sheeting. 4" x 6" stringers. 4' C to C hangers. Cleatsand 4" x 6" cross bracing spaced 7' C to C.
2. Design of shoring and sheeting will vary with soil conditions, width and depth of trench, etc.
3. Installation should be in accordance with the National Safety Council Industrial Data Sheets No. 254(Trench Excavation) and No. 482 (General Excavation), or designed by a competent engineer.
4-25
TABLE 4-18. Material Weights and Swell Factors
Material # per CD # per CD % of Swell Swell Factor(Loose) (In Place)
Cement, Portland 2450 2950 20 .83
Clay, Natural Red 2700 3500 30 .77Clay and Gravel, Dry 2300 3100 34 .74Clay and Gravel, Wet 2600 3500 34 .72
Concrete 2650 3700 40 .72Concrete, Wet Mix 3600 3600 40 .72
Earth, Loam, Dry 2300 2850 25 .81Earth, Loam, Wet 2750 3400 24 .81
Granite 2800 4560 65 .60
Gravel, 1/4 to 2 IN, Dry 2850 3200 12 .89Gravel, 1/4 to 2 IN, Wet 3200 3600 13 .89
Laterite 3900 5200 33 .75
Limestone, Blasted 2500 4250 69 .59Limestone, Crushed 2700 4500 67 .60Limestone, Marble 2700 4500 69 .59
Mud, Dry 2100 2550 21 .82Mud, Wet 2650 3200 21 .83
Sand, Dry 2750 3100 13 .89Sand, Wet 3150 3600 14 .88
Sandstone, Shot 2700 4250 58 .64
Shale, Riprap 2100 2800 33 .75
Slate 3600 4700 30 .77
Coral, Class #2, Soft 2030 2900 67 .60Coral, Class #1, Hard 2440 4075
NOTES: 1. Percent of Swell times the bank (in place) CD equals the loose cubic yards to be moved.
2. Swell Factor times the loose cubic yards equals bank cubic yards being moved.
3. Compaction Factor times the volume of the fill equals the loose material required for compactedfill.
4-26
TABLE 4-19. Dump Trucks Production
Dump Truck Production Hour per Loose Cubic Yards
Average Speed
Average Haul Distance One Way
1 MI 2 MI 3 MI 4 MI 5 MI
10 MPH 0.0877 (1342) 0.1429 (1346) 0.2 (1350) 0.25 (1354) 0.303 (1358)15 MPH 0.068 (1343) 0.1064 (1347) 0.1429 (1351) 0.1786 (1355) 0.2174 (1359)20 MPH 0.0595 (1344) 0.087 (1348) 0.1149 (1352) 0.1429 (1356) 0.1695 (1360)30 MPH 0.0505 (1345) 0.069 (1349) 0.087 (1353) 0.1053 (1357) 0.125 (1361)
NOTES: 1. All figures are in loose CD for 5-ton military dump trucks.2. For 15-ton civilian trucks use 2 multiplier.3. 2.5 CD F.E.L. required to load 5-ton trucks. 4 CD F.E.L. for 15-ton trucks.4. Table based on loading time of 4 min. and a dumping time of 3 min.
TABLE 4-20. Wheel Tractor Scrapers Production
Wheel Tractor Scraper Production Hour per Loose Cubic Yard
Scraper SizeOne Way Haul Distance (FT)
1000 2000 3000 4000 5000
14-18 LCD 0.0082 (1372) 0.0116 (1373) 0.0159 (1374) 0.02 (1375) 0.0233 (1376)21-31 LCD 0.0038 (1377) 0.0061 (1378) 0.0083 (1379) 0.0105 (1380) 0.0123 (1381)
NOTES: 1. All figures in loose CD.2. Estimates figures on required size crawler tractor push loading.
4-27
TABLE 4-21. Motor Grader Production
Motor Grader Production, Hour per Bank Cubic Yard (BCD)
Type of Operation Hour per Bank Cubic Yard
Cut "V" Ditch, Easy Soil 0.006 (1392)Cut "V" Ditch, Medium Soil 0.01 (1393)Cut "V" Ditch, Hard Soil 0.0175 (1394)Trim and Spread Material 0.0133 (1395)
Motor Grader Grading Production, Hour per Square Foot
Type of Operation Hour per Square Foot
Shape Banks and Slopes 0.0013 (1396)Rough Grade 0.0004 (1397)Fine Grade (Blue Top) 0.0017 (1398)
SUGGESTED CREW SIZE: For fine grading, one EO, one grade checker.
NOTES: 1. All figures are in bank CD.2. For small areas that require directional changes and maneuvering, use 2.0 multiplier.
TABLE 4-22. Compaction Factors
Material (Compacted) Multiplier
Sand 1.17Loam 1.39Clay 1.59Rock (blasted) 1.15Coral 1.15
NOTE: 1. Cubic volume in place times the multiplier equals the cubic yards of loose material to be moved.
4-28
TABLE 4-23. Rollers (Hourly Production)
Roller Production: Hour per Compacted Cubic Yard (CCD/HR)
Type of Roller Speed Lift in Number of Passesin MPH Inches
3 4 5 6
Towed Grid 5 6 0.0018 (1402) 0.0025 (1403) 0.0031 (1404) 0.0037 (1405)
Vibratory 2 6 0.0034 (1406) 0.0046 (1407) 0.0057 (1408) 0.0069 (1409)
Smooth Steel Drums 1.5 3 0.0093 (1410) 0.0122 (1411) 0.0154 (1412) 0.0185 (1413)
Multi-Tired Pneumatic 2 3 0.0079 (1414) 0.0105 (1415) 0.0132 (1416) 0.0156 (1417)
High Speed Tamping Foot 6 6 0.0011 (1418) 0.0015 (1419) 0.0019 (1420) 0.0023 (1421)
NOTES: 1. All figures are in HR /compacted CD2. Use table 4-18 to estimate loose CD of fill requirements.3. For small areas that require more directional changes and maneuvering, use .5 multiplier4. The number of machine passes required is dependent on soil type, moisture content, desired density,and machine compactive effort.5. The number of passes can only be determined by testing the density of the compacted material onsite.
TABLE 4-24. Seal Coats
Work Element Description Unit Man-Hours Per Unit
Load Distributor Trk. from Drums GL 0.009 (1123)Load Distributor Trk. from Tank GL 0.003 (1124)Heat GL 0.004 (1125)Hand Spray from Distributor Trk. GL 0.003 (1126)Apply Print, Tack, Seal Coat 12 FT Bar GL 0.001 (1127)Sweep Base with Tractor Mtd. SY 0.001 (1128)Spread Aggregate with 8-FT wide Spreader Box SY 0.001 (1129)
SUGGESTED CREW SIZE: Loading distributor, three EOs for drums, two EOs for tank Heating asphalt, two EOs Hand spraying asphalt, three EOs 12-FT spray bar, two EOs Spread aggregate, two EOs
NOTES: 1. Drum loading is figured on top loading using a crane or forklift to raise drums.2. Dump truck and man-hours are not included in estimate for spreading aggregate, see table 4-19.
4-29
TABLE 4-25. Bituminous Paving
Work Element Description Unit Man-Hours Per Unit
Asphalt Walks/Hand Spread: Form Work FT 0.04 (1130) Spread Asphalt SF 0.025 (1131) Hand Compact/Roll SF 0.008 (1132)
Asphalt Paver: Paving with Asphalt Finisher TN 0.09 (1133)
Mix in place 2-inch thick with grader SY 0.002 (1134)
Intermediate Roll SY 0.002 (1135)
Finish Roll SY 0.003 (1136)
SUGGESTED CREW SIZE: Asphalt paver. One operator, one screed man, and fourlaborers with hand toolsHand spread, 4-12 men. Spreading, leveling, forming, 2-3men.
NOTE: 1. Asphalt paving figures based on actual laydown time on straight course. When parking lots or shortcourses are to be laid, double the estimate.
TABLE 4-26. Rock Drilling and Blasting
Work Element Description Unit Man-HoursPer Unit
Drill Holes: Sinker Drill 2.5" dia. med. FT 0.2 (1137) Sinker Drill 2.5" dia. hard FT 0.3 (1138) Air Trac 2.5" dia. med. FT 0.09 (1139) Air Trac 2.5" dia. hard FT 0.14 (1140)
Load and Shoot Holes EA 0.5 (1141)
SUGGESTED CREW SIZE: Sinker Drill (Jack Hammer) one man per drill.Air Trac Driffer Drill two EOs per drill.Load/Shoot 4-20 men.
NOTES: 1. Times may vary depending on type of rock, equipment and/or explosives.2. Figures for blasting are for stick dynamite.
4-30
TABLE 4-27. Hand Excavation
Work Element Description Unit Man-Hours Per Unit
General Excavation of Earth CD 2.7 (1142)Trenches to 5' in Earth CD 2.2 (1143)Post Holes. Small 3' deep FT 0.5 (1144)Fill Wheelbarrel, Georgia Buggys, and Haul CD 1.9 (1145)Spread Excess Earth CD 0.9 (1146)Trim and Fine Grade SF 0.019 (1147)Hand Compact w/Pneumatic CD 0.8 (1148)Hand Compact w/Vibratory CD 0.2 (1149)
NOTE: 1. When wheeling over 100 FT, use 1.25 multiplier for each additional 40 FT
TABLE 4-28. Erosion Control
Work Element Description Unit Man-HoursPer Unit
Place Jute Mesh, Plastic Netting, or Polyropylene Membrane SY 0.0143 (1150)
Machine Place RIPRAP Class "C" Material CD 0.012 (1151)
Hand Fill Voids in RIPRAP SY 1.6 (1152)
SUGGESTED CREW SIZE: Place membrane/mesh 4-80 men.Place RIPRAP: two EOs for crane, using tongs/clamshell,with two men on tag lines placing rock.
NOTE: 1. Placing RIPRAP should entail 120 man-hours if interlocked.
4-31
TABLE 4-29. Landscape
Work Element Description Unit Man-Hours Per Unit
Spread Topsoil with Machine CD 0.22 (1000)Top Dress by Hand (Rake and Clean) SY 0.079 (1001)Seed and Fertilize by Hand SY 0.105 (1002)Hydro-Mulch SY 0.013 (1003)Plant Shrubs, 1 Gallon Size EA 0.5 (1004)
SUGGESTED CREW SIZE: Spreading topsoil with equipment, one to two EOs.Top dress by hand, 1-20 men with hand tools.Seed and fertilize by hand, two to six men with hand tools.Hydro-Mulch, three EOs.Plant shrubs, one to six men with hand tools.
NOTE: 1. Hydro-Mulch figure based on 1,000-gallon capacity machine and includes charging time.
TABLE 4-30. Fencing
Work Element Description Unit Man-Hours Per Unit
Install Wood Fence 4' High SF 0.054 (1005)
Install Metal Fence 5' High Chainlink FT 0.219 (1006)Install Metal Fence 8' High Chanlink FT 0.244 (1007)
Hang Gates Leaf 8.0 (1008)
SUGGESTED CREW SIZE: Digging Operations, one EO, auger truckFencing Operations, four to six laborers
NOTES: 1. Fence installation includes: Digging Holes; Unloading and distributing materials; Setting,plumbing, aligning, and concreting posts; Installing braces: Stretching and fastening fence fabric; Installing caps or brackets on posts; and Stringing lone and barbed wire.
2. Hanging gates includes installation of hardware.
4-32
TABLE 4-31. Concrete Culvert Pipe Installation
Work Element Description Unit Man-Hours Per Unit
Install Concrete Pipe Laying Lengths
15"' to 18 " I.D. 3 FT FT 0.48 (1009) 18 " to 24" I.D. 4 FT FT 0.64 (1010) 30 " to 48 " I.D. 5 FT FT 0.88 (1011) 48 " to 72 " I.D. 5 FT FT 1.12 (1012)
SUGGESTED CREW SIZE: Crane Operations: one EO. Cherry Picker; one EOsignalman. Installing Operations: three to seven laborers,depending on pipe size.
NOTES: 1. Work includes handling, placing, caulking, grouting and bedding pipe.2. Adjust man-hour figures for laying lengths, other than indicated in table.3. If gasket of spediseal-type joints are used, use 0.8 multiplier4. For headways, drop inlets, catch basins, and other drainage structures. Refer to Division 3.5. For excavation and backfill, refer to tables 4-11 and 4-16.6. For sheeting and shoring of banks of excavations, refer to table 4-18.
TABLE 4-32. Galvanized Culvert Installation
Work Element Description Unit Man-Hours Per Unit
Install Galvanized Pipe Culverts12 " to 24 " FT 0.32 (1013)26 " to 45 " FT 0.5 (1014)48 " to 72 " FT 0.72 (1015)
Install Galvanized Culvert (Bolted)12 " to 24 " FT 0.48 (1016)26 " to 45 " FT 0.65 (1017)48 " to 72" FT 0.88 (1018)
SUGGESTED CREW SIZE: Three to seven laborers, depending on size of culvert to beinstalled.
NOTES: 1. Installation of galvanized culvert includes unloading, fine grading, placing, caulking, and installingjoint clamps.2. Installation of galvanized culvert (bolted) includes bolting together of sections, unloading, finegrading, and placement.3. Man-Hour estimates for galvanized culvert (bolted) are based on sections being bolted into desiredlengths in a prefabrication yard.4. When installing culverts over 48 " in diameter, it is recommended that cross bridging be used toprevent culverts from being bent or twisted during hauling or installation. Cross bridging can easily beremoved upon completion of backfilling and compaction.
4-33
TABLE 4-33. Piledriving
Work Element Description Unit Man-Hours PerUnit
25 FT Wood Piling Each 3.0 (1019)50 FT Wood Piling Each 6.5 (1020)75 FT Wood Piling Each 9.6 (1021)
25 FT Steel Piling Each 4.0 (1022)50 FT Steel Piling Each 7.2 (1023)75 FT Steel Piling Each 12.0 (1024)
40 FT Precast Concrete Piling Each 13.2 (1025)60 FT Precast Concrete Piling Each 18.0 (1026)80 FT Precast Concrete Piling Each 24.0 (1027)
Steel Sheet Piling SF 0.102 (1028)
Assemble and Rig Leads and Hammer Each 48.0 (1029)
Dismantle Leads and Hammer Each 32.0 (1030)
SUGGESTED CREW SIZE: Two EOs, two EAs, six to ten BUs.
NOTES: 1. Man-Hour figures are preliminary estimate only. The many variables of this work require on-sitedeterminations for accurate estimates.2. Factors of importance are: Design, soil, equipment and method used, tides, access to site, currents,materials storage, etc.3. Work included is preparation of pile, placing in leads, driving and cut off.4. For concrete filled, fluted hollow steel piling and pipe piling for spudding pontoon small craft fingerpiers, use the steel bearing pile figures.
TABLE 4-34. Miscellaneous Pier Hardware
Work Element Description Unit Man-Hours PerUnit
Bits Each 13.0 (1031)Bollards Each 16.0 (1032)Chocks Each 13.0 (1033)Cleats Each 11.0 (1034)Padeyes Each 2.5 (1035)
SUGGESTED CREW SIZE: Two EOs, two Bus
4-34
TABLE 4-35. Wood Pile Dolphins
Work Element Description Unit Man-Hours Per Unit
Place in Leads and Drive Each 0.80 (1036)Lash with Wire Rope Each 0.75 (1037)Install Fenders Each 0.60 (1038)Fender Pile Each 0.75 (1039)
SUGGESTED CREW SIZE: Two EOs, two EAs, Six to eight BUs.
NOTE: 1. Based on 50 FT piles.
TABLE 4-36. Pier Framing
Work Element Description Unit Man-HoursPer Unit
Stringers BF 0.024 (1040)Bridging FT 0.144 (1041)Decking (4" thick) FT 0.056 (1042)Wearing Surface (2" thick) FT 0.032 (1043)Bull Rail FT 0.32 (1044)Bumpers FT 0.288 (1045)For Quick Estimates: Pier Framing Complete (less Piles, Capping, Bracing) SF 0.176 (1046)
SUGGESTED CREW SIZE: Two EOs, six to ten BUs.
NOTE: 1. Estimates include precutting, bolting, or drifting members in place.
TABLE 4-37. Pile Bracing and Capping
Work Element Description Unit Man-Hours Per Unit
Diagonal Bracing EA 6.5 (1047)Horizontal Bracing EA 4.0 (1048)Wood Caps FT 0.48 (1049)Concrete Caps FT 3.2 (1050)Steel Caps FT 0.48 (1051)
SUGGEST CREW SIZE: Four to eight Bus.
NOTE: 1. Based on bolting or drifting members in place.
4-35
TABLE 4-38. Pile Extraction
Work Element Description Unit Man-HoursPer Unit
Wood Bearing Piles EA 2.0 (1052)Wood Sheet Piling SF 0.024 (1053)Steel Sheet Piling SF 0.028 (1054)Piles Cut Off Below Water Line EA 2.5 (1055)
SUGGESTED CREW SIZE: Two EOs, two to four BUs.
NOTE: 1. Based on using pile extractor.
4-36
This page is blank
4-37
DIVISION 3. CONCRETE CONSTRUCTIONPage
A. FORM WORKTable 4-39 Form Work . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-37
B. REINFORCING STEELTable 4-40 Reinforcing Steel Fabrication . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-38Table 4-41 Numbers, Sizes, Areas, and Weights of Bars . . . . . . . . . . . 4-38Table 4-42 Placing Reinforcing Steel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-39
C. MIXING CONCRETETable 4-43 Mixing Concrete . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-40
D. PLACING AND FINISHINGTable 4-44 Placing Concrete . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-41Table 4-45 Finishing and Curing Concrete . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-41
E. MISCELLANEOUS AND IMBEDDED ITEMSTable 4-46 Miscellaneous and Imbeded Items . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-42Table 4-47 Concrete Requirements for Footings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-43Table 4-48 Volume Factors of Various Mixes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-43Table 4-49 Materials for 100 SF of Concrete . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-45Table 4-50 Concrete Requirements for Slabs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-45Table 4-51 Concrete Requirements for Walls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-46Table 4-52 How to Change Cubic Feet to Cubic Yard . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-47Table 4-53 Concrete Compressive Strength . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-48Table 4-54 Conversion and Waste Factors: Concrete Construction . . . . 4-49Table 4-55 Material Weights and Measures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-50
4-38
This page is blank
4-39
TABLE 4-39. Form Work
Work Element Description Unit Man-Hours Per Unit
Fabricate Erect Strip Repair
Footing, Foundation Walls, and Grade Beams SFCS 0.09 (2001) 0.07 (2002) 0.04 (2003) 0.04 (2004)
Slabs on Grade and Screed -----------------0.13 Complete----------------(up to 8" thick including edge form) (2005)SFCS
Thicken Edge and Slabs Greater Than 8" Thick. Use Grade Beam Estimate.
Walls to 10FT High SFCS 0.08 (2007) 0.07 (2008) 0.05 (2009) 0.05 (2010)
Columns and Piers SFCS 0.09 (2011) 0.1(2012) 0.05 (2013) 0.05 (2014)
Suspended Slabs SFCS 0.08 (2015) 0.12 (2016) 0.04 (2017) 0.05 (2018)
Beams and Girders SFCS 0.11 (2019) 0.1 (2020) 0.05 (2021) 0.05 (2022)
Stairs SFCS ----------------- 0.55 (2023) Complete----------------
SUGGESTED CREW SIZE: Forming/Stripping, five BUsForming/Stripping (Gang forms), five BUS, two EOs
NOTES: 1. Concrete forming estimates are based on using form accessories, form ties, and steel columnclamps.
2. Suspended slabs, beam, and girders are figures using 4" x 4" shores and wooden wedges. Foradjustable shores, use .9 multiplier3. When forming and stripping are combined, stripping and cleaning forms will be approximately 17percent of total labor.
4. On multiple use jobs allow three man-hours for form repair per 100 SF of contact surface after fouruses.
5. Gang forming usually requires a crane, an operator, and a signalman.
6. Forming walls over 10 FT high, and other high work will increase erection time, to compensateuse 1.1 - 1.5 multiplier depending on job complexity.
4-40
TABLE 4-40. Reinforcing Steel Fabrication
Man-Hours Required for Making 1 Bend or Hook
Size of Bar (inches)
By Hand By Machine
Hours/ Bend Hours/ Hook Hours/ Bend Hours/ Hook
½ or less 0.04 (2024) 0.06 (2025) 0.015 (2026) 0.025 (2027)
5/8, 3/4, 7/8 0.05 (2028) 0.02 (2030) 0.02 (2029) 0.03 (2031)
1 and 1-1/8 0.06 (2032) 0.1 (2033) 0.025 (2034) 0.04 (2035)
1-1/4 and 1-1/2 0.07 (2036) 0.12 (2037) 0.03 (2038) 0.05 (2039)
SUGGESTED CREW SIZE: Two to eight SWs, depending on amount of reinforcingsteel to be cut and/or bent.
NOTE: 1. Reinforcing steel fabrication includes cutting, banding, tagging. Assembly and tying into mats andbeams in the shop are also included.
TABLE 4-41. Numbers, Sizes, Areas, and Weights of Bars
Bar Size Area Weight Waste Number (Dia. IN) (Sq. IN) (LB Per FT) (Percent)
2* 1/4 0.049 0.167 103 3/8 0.110 0.376 104 ½ 0.196 0.668 105 5/8 0.307 1.043 106 3/4 0.442 1.502 107 7/8 0.601 2.044 108 1 0.785 2.670 10
9+ 1-1/8 1.000 3.4 1010+ 1-1/4 1.2656 4.30 1011+ 1-3/8 2.405 5.31 1014 1-3/4 3.976 8.18 1018 2-1/4 13.52 10
LEGEND: * = No. 2 bar is a plain round bar+ = Nos. 9, 10, 11 correspond to the old 1-, 1-1/8, and 1-1/4 inch. square bars,and are equivalent to those three square bars in weights and nominal cross-sectional areas.
Splicing is equal to 30 times diameter, or a minimum of 12 inches per splice, or whichever is greater.
4-41
TABLE 4-42. Placing Reinforcing Steel
Labor Hours for Placing 1 Bar
Bar size in Inches Length of Bar in Feet
Under 10 10 - 20 20 - 30
½ or less 0.06 (2068) 0.07 (2069) 0.08 (2070)5/8, 3/4, and 7/8 0.07 (2071) 0.08 (2072) 0.095 (2073)1 and 1-1/8 0.08 (2074) 0.1 (2075) 0.115 (2076)1-1/4 and 1-1/2 0.09 (2077) 0.12 (2078) 0.14 (2079)
Welded Wire Fabric Unit Man-Hours
Slabs on Grade, Concrete SF 0.08 (2080)Paving, Precast Roof Panels
Gunite and Head Walls SF 0.01 (2081)
SUGGESTED CREW SIZE: Two to six SWs
NOTES: 1. Placement of reinforcing steel includes handling into place, tying, supporting, and any cuttingwhich becomes necessary at the site, such as cutting around imbedded items or cutting stock lengths ofstraight bars to fit slab dimensions.
2. Man-Hour estimates are based on all reinforcing steel being shop fabricated (cut to length and bentready to place in the structure).
3. If reinforcing steel is to be welded in place,use 1.5 multiplier.
4. Order three 4-LB rolls of the wire for each ton of rebar ( 16 GA black annealed wire).
4-42
TABLE 4-43. Mixing Concrete
Work Element Description Unit Man-Hours Per Unit
Hand Mixing on Site:
2 Boards or Boats CD 3.2 (2040)
Machine Mixing on Site:(16 S Mixer) CD 1.6 (2041)(11 S Mixer) CD 2.7 (2042)
Transit Mix Truck CD 0.56 (2043)
SUGGESTED CREW SIZE: Refer to Notes.
NOTES: 1. Hand mixing tables are based on enough men to keep a smooth constant flow of materials,approximately eight men. Man-hour figure (hand) does not include placing. Maximum output about20 CD per day.
2. Hand mixing using two boards eliminates waiting for a batch to be mixed before dry charging themixing board, as the mixer alternate boards. With twelve men the maximum output is about 28 CDper day.
3. Warm weather (90 to 100 degrees) will slow mixing time and add 0.5 man-hours per CD.
4. Labor to charge a 16 S Mixer can be reduced by the use of a small front end loader, but at least oneman must remain on each aggregate stock pile to monitor bucket loading.
5. Transit mix man-hours are based on using four trucks, average haul of five miles, and four menoperating a dry cement batching plant (Ross or equal).
6. Large paving job man-day estimates are dependent on equipment used, manufacturers ratings andrecommendations.
7. 11 S Mixer replaces 16 S Mixer in the NCF.
4-43
TABLE 4-44. Placing Concrete
Man-Hours Per Unit
Work Element Unit Direct From Wheeled Pumped CraneDescription Chute and
Bucket
Place Footings,Foundations:
Grade Beams CD 1.0 (2044) 2.0 (2045) 1.50 (2046) 1.50 (2047) Slabs on Grade CD 1.5 (2048) 3.0 (2049) 2.00 (2050) 2.50 (2051) Walls to 10' High CD -- -- 1.68 (2052) 2.24 (2053) Columns CD -- -- 1.68 (2054) 2.24 (2055) Suspended Slabs CD -- -- 1.68 (2056) 2.24 (2057) Beams and Girders CD -- -- 1.68 (2058) 2.24 (2059) Stairs CD 2.4 (2060) 4.8 (2061) 1.68 (2062) 2.88 (2063)
NOTES: 1. For each 40 feet wheeled add 25 percent.2. For upper stories, add per story: Placed by pump, use1.07 multiplier; placed by bucket or crane,use 1.05 multiplier.3. Construction that moves in and out of ramps, runways, or staging is not included. For moving andin and out use 0.22 man-hours per linear foot.4. Major items of consideration in planning concrete placement are: Method of placement,accessability, the rate of placement in regard to form design, the amount and frequency of delivery isgoverned by the ability to screed, tamp, and finish.
TABLE 4-45. Finishing and Curing Concrete
Work Element Description Unit Man-Hours Per Unit
FinishingSteel Trowel: Machine SF 0.015 (2106) Hand SF 0.03 (2064) Float Only SF 0.025 (2065)CuringLiquid Spray, Membrane, Burlap, Water Spray SF 0.005 (2066)Cold Weather Protection CD 0.5 (2067)
SUGGESTED CREW SIZE: Four to eight BUS, depending on size of pour and type offinish.
NOTE: 1. Cold weather protection figure is average. Variations depend on method, additives, straw andtarps, heated aggregate, salamanders, etc.
4-44
TABLE 4-46. Miscellaneous and Imbedded Items
Work Element Description Unit Man-Hours PerUnit
Anchor Bolts EA 0.08 (2082)Pickup and Brace Inserts EA 0.064 (2083)Curb Angles FT 0.16 (2084)Ceiling Inserts EA 0.06 (2085)Dovetail Anchor Slots FT 0.0023 (2086)Steel Base Plates 12" X 14" X ½" EA 1.0 (2087)Reglets (metal or PVD) FT 0.1 (2088)Waterstops (PVC dumbells or copper) FT 0.04 (2089)Premolded Expansion Joint FT 0.04 (2090)Poured Expansion Joint ½" X ½" FT 0.04 (2091)Vapor Barriers SF 0.02 (2092)Floor Hardeners (Magnesium Fluosilicate) 1 coat SF 0.01 (2093)Silicon Waterproofing SF 0.01 (2094)Acid Wash (walls) SF 0.02 (2095)Patch Tie Holes (walls) EA 0.05 (2096)Nonshrink Grout under Steel Plate, 1" SF 1.0 (2097)Carborundum Rub SF 0.04 (2098)Concrete Cutting --OLD 2" deep cut FT 0.08 (2099) 4" deep cut FT 0.12 (2100) --Green 2" deep cut FT 0.05 (2101) 4" deep cut FT 0.08 (2102)
Concrete Core Drilling Slab Vertical 3" dia. X 6" thick EA 2.0 (2103) Wall Horiz. 4" dia. X 8" thick EA 2.5 (2104)Architectural concrete: patched, honed, sack rubbed SF 0.08 (2105)
NOTES: 1. Tables are for installation only, and do not include fabrication time.2. Premolded expansion joint figures is based on material ½-inch thick, and of sufficient width toextend the required depth. Use 1.15 multiplier for 1-inch material.3. Concrete sawing is based on 4,000 FT per inch blade life, which reduces in proportion to depth.4. Core drilling labor varies if slabs or walls are heavily reinforced with 3/4 inch to 1-1/2 inch rebar,or holes are widely spaced.
4-45
TABLE 4-47. Concrete Requirements for Footings
Amount of Concrete Required
Footing Size CF per FT CF per 100 FT CD per 100 FT(Inches)
6 x 12 0.50 50.00 1.98 x 12 0.67 66.67 2.58 x 16 0.89 88.89 3.38 x 18 1.00 100.00 3.7
10 x 12 0.83 83.33 3.110 x 16 1.11 111.11 4.112 x 12 1.00 100.00 3.712 x 16 1.33 133.33 4.912 x 20 1.67 166.67 6.112 x 24 2.00 200.00 7.4
TABLE 4-48. Volume Factors of Various Mixes
Mix by Volume Job Damp Materials
Kind of Cement Sand Stone, Workability, One BagConcrete Work Bags (CF) Gravel (CF) Consistency Batch = CF
Footings, Heavy 1 3.75 5.0 stiff 6.2Foundations
Watertight Concrete forCellar Walls and Walls 1 2.5 3.5 medium 4.5Above Ground
Driveways, Floors, 1 2.5 3.0 stiff 4.1Walks --One Course
Driveways, Floors, 1 Top 2.0 0.0 stiff 2.14Walks --Two Course Base 2.5 4.0 stiff 4.8
Pavements 1 2.2 3.5 stiff 4.2
Watertight Concrete forTanks, Cisterns,Precast Units (Piles, 1 2.0 3.0 medium 3.8Posts, Thin Reinforced wet 3.9Slabs, etc.)
Heavy Duty Floors 1 1.25 2.0 stiff 2.8
Table continued next page.......
4-46
TABLE 4-48. Volume Factors of Various Mixes (Continued)
Materials for One CD of Concrete
Kind of Total Water Cement Bags Sand Stone, GravelConcrete Work per Bag (CF) (CF)
(GL)
Footings, Heavy 8.0 4.3 16.3 21.7Foundations
Watertight Concretefor Cellar Walls and 6.0 6.0 15.0 21.0Walls Above Ground
Driveways, Floors, 5.5 6.5 16.3 19.5Walks --One Course
Driveways, Floors, Top ---- 12.6 25.2 ----Walks --Two Course Base 6.0 5.7 14.2 22.8
Pavements 5.25 6.4 14.1 22.4
Watertight Concretefor Tanks, Cisternsand Precast Units medium 5.0 7.1 14.2 21.3(Piles, Posts, Thin wet 5.75 6.9 13.8 20.7Reinforced Slabs, etc.
Heavy Duty Floors -- 9.8 12.3 19.6
4-47
TABLE 4-49. Materials for 100 Square Feet of Concrete
Concrete Base
1 : 1-3/4 : 2-3/4 1 : 2 : 3
Slab Thickness Cement Sand Stone Cement Sand Stone(Inches) Bags (CD) (CD) Bags (CD) (CD)
2.5 5.7 0.36 0.62 5.2 0.40 0.593.0 6.8 0.43 0.74 6.3 0.48 0.713.5 8.0 0.51 0.86 7.3 0.56 0.834.0 9.1 0.58 0.99 8.4 0.64 0.954.5 10.3 0.65 1.11 9.4 0.72 1.065.0 11.4 0.73 1.23 10.5 0.80 1.195.5 12.6 0.80 1.36 11.6 0.88 1.316.0 13.7 0.87 1.48 12.6 0.96 1.42
Concrete Base
1 : 2-1/2 : 4 1 : 3 : 5
Slab Thickness Cement Sand Stone Cement Sand Stone(Inches) Bags (CD) (CD) Bags (CD) (CD)
2.5 4.2 0.40 0.63 3.4 0.39 0.653.0 5.0 0.48 0.75 4.1 0.47 0.783.5 5.8 0.56 0.88 4.8 0.55 0.924.0 6.6 0.64 1.01 5.5 0.63 1.054.5 7.5 0.72 1.13 6.1 0.70 1.175.0 8.3 0.80 1.26 6.8 0.79 1.315.5 9.2 0.88 1.39 7.5 0.87 1.456.0 10.0 0.96 1.52 8.2 0.94 1.57
TABLE 4-50. Concrete Requirements for Slabs
Slab Thickness CF of Concrete Required Slab Area Coverage(Inches) per SF of Slab SF per CD
2 0.167 1623 0.250 1084 0.333 815 0.417 656 0.500 54
4-48
TABLE 4-51. Concrete Requirements for Walls
Concrete Required per 100 SF of Wall
Wall Thickness (Inches) CF CD
4 33.3 1.246 50.0 1.858 66.7 2.47
10 83.3 3.9012 100.0 3.70
4-49
TABLE 4-52. How to Change Cubic Feet to Cubic Yard
CF CD CF CD CF CD
1 0.37 10 .370 19 .7032 0.74 11 .407 20 .7403 .111 12 .444 21 .7774 .148 13 .481 22 .8145 .185 14 .518 23 .8516 .222 15 .555 24 .8887 .259 16 .592 25 .9258 .296 17 .629 26 .9629 .333 18 .666 27 1 or .999
While the table may be useful for reference, the figure .037 is the only one that youmust remember, because of the fact that there are .037 cubic yards to 1 cubic foot.
1. The usual procedure is to divide the amount of cubic feet by 27 to find the number of cubicyards. The .037 rule is faster and more accurate than the division method.
2. The 037 rule is a decimal equivalent. If you divide one number by a larger one, you get adecimal equivalent. Therefore, if you divide the number "1" by "27" you will find that you willget a decimal .0370370. For estimating purposes, it is not necessary to extend decimals beyondthree spaces.Thus:
1/27 of 1 = 0.037 1 CF = 0.037 CD1/27 of 10 = 0.370 10 CF = 0.370 CD1/27 of 100 = 3.700 100 CF = 3.700 CD
3. Estimators work from "squares" or 100 square feet (SF). Hence, an excavation of 20 FT x 20FT covers 400 SF., or 4 squares. If there are 3.7 cubic yards (CD) for each 100 SF for eachfoot of depth, then excavation amounts to 4 X 3.7 = 14.8 CD per foot; and if at a 4 FT depth,there would be 14.8 X 4 = 59.2 CD total.
4. Extending the .037 method is far more useful in figuring trenches and other tricky problems.
EXAMPLE (1): Assume you have a trench 65-FT long X 2-FT wide X 2-FT deep. Thecross-sectional area is 4 SF, therefore, it actually contains 4/27 of a CD per foot in length. Fromthe table you will find the decimal equivalent of 4 is .148. Thus, .148 X 65 = 9.6 CD in thistrench.
EXAMPLE (2): A basement is 24-FT long X 30-FT wide X 6-FT deep. 24 X 30 =720: 720 X 6 = 4,320 CF in excavation. Convert this into CD by two methods:
(1) 4,320 X .037 = 159.84 or 160 CD(2) From the table use 4 and move decimal 3 places . . . . . . . . . = 48.000 From the table use 3 and move decimal 2 places . . . . . . . . . = 11.100 From table use 20 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . = .740
159.840
4-50
TABLE 4-53. Concrete Compressive StrengthPlain Concrete (Proper Curing Conditions)
4-51
TABLE 4-54. Conversion and Waste Factors: Concrete Construction
Material Conversion Percent Waste
Concrete (1:2:4)Cement 6.0 SK/ CD 10Fine aggregate 0.5 CD/ CD 10Coarse aggregate 0.9 CD/ CD 10
Curing Compound 0.5 GAL/ 100 SF 10
FormsFootings and piers 2 X 4 1.5 FT / SFCS 20 2 X 8 0.2 FT / SFCS 10 2 X 12 0.7 FT / SFCS 5
Walls and columns 2 X 4 1.3 FT / SFCS 20 Plywood (50% reuse) 0.5 SF / SFCS 5
Beams and susp. slabs 1 X 6 0.3 FT / SFCS 5 2 X 4 0.5 FT / SFCS 20 2 X 10 0.1 FT / SFCS 10 4 X 4 0.4 FT / SFCS 5 4 X 6 0.1 FT / SFCS 5 Plywood 0.5 SF / SFCS 5 Form oil 0.5 GL / 100 SF 10 Tie wire 12.0 LB / TON 5 Snap tie wedges 0.1 EA / SFCS 5 Snap ties 0.1 EA / SFCS 5 She bolts 0.1 SE / SFCS Nails (BF lumber + SF)Plywood, ordered as MFBM 6d box 6 LB / MFBM 10 8d common 4 LB / MFBM 10 16d common 6 LB / MFBM 10 20d common 2 LB / MFBM 10 6d duplex 4 LB / MFBM 10 8d duplex 9 LB / MFBM 10 16d duplex 9 LB / MFBM 10
4-52
TABLE 4-55. Material Weights and Measures
Material Weight WeightLB / CF LB / CD
Concrete Cinder 112 Gravel/ Limestone 150 Reinforced 150
Crushed Stone 100 2,700
Gravel 95 2,565
Hydrated Lime 40
Mortar 103
Sand Dry 97 to 117 2,619 to 3,159 Wet 120 to 140 3,240 to 3,780
Slag 70 1,755 to 1,890
Stone Riprap 65 1,775
Wood Douglas Fir 34 Oak 46 Western Hemlock 29
4-53
DIVISION 4. MASONRY
Page
A. CONCRETE BLOCK, COMMON BLOCK, AND RUBBLE MASONRYTable 4-56 Length of Concrete Masonry Walls by Stretchers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-53Table 4-57 Height of Concrete Masonry Walls by Courses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-54Table 4-58 Block, Brick, and Rubble Masonry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-55
B. CERAMIC, QUARY, AND STRUCTURAL FACING TILETable 4-59 Tile Masonry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-56
C. MISCELLANEOUS MASONRYTable 4-60 Volume of Grout in Grouted CMU Walls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-57Table 4-61 Maximum Unsupported Heights of
CMU Walls During Construction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-57Table 4-62 Masonry Conversion Units . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-58Table 4-63 Material Weights and Measures: Masonry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-59
4-54
This page is blank
4-55
TABLE 4-56. Length of Concrete Masonry Walls by Stretchers
*Based on units 15-3/8 inches long and half units 7-5/8 inches long, with 3/8-inch thick headjoints.
Number of Stretchers Wall Length*
1.0 1 FT 4 IN1.5 2 FT 0 IN2.0 2 FT 8 IN
2.5 3 FT 4 IN3.0 4 FT 0 IN3.5 4 FT 8 IN
4.0 5 FT 4 IN4.5 6 FT 0 IN5.0 6 FT 8 IN
5.5 7 FT 4 IN6.0 8 FT 0 IN6.5 8 FT 8 IN
7.0 9 FT 4 IN7.5 10 FT 0 IN8.0 10 FT 8 IN
8.5 11 FT 4 IN9.0 12 FT 0 IN9.5 12 FT 8 IN
10.0 13 FT 4 IN10.5 14 FT 0 IN11.0 14 FT 8 IN
11.5 15 FT 4 IN12.0 16 FT 0 IN12.5 16 FT 8 IN
13.0 17 FT 4 IN13.5 18 FT 0 IN14.0 18 FT 8 IN
14.5 19 FT 4 IN15.0 20 FT 0 IN20.0 26 FT 8 IN
4-56
TABLE 4-57. Height of Concrete Masonry Walls by Courses
Wall Height
3/8-IN Bed Joint 7/16-IN Bed Joint ½-IN Bed Joint
No. of 8-IN 4-IN 8-IN 4-IN 8-IN 4-IN Courses Block Block Block Block Block Block
1 8" 4" 8-1/16" 4-1/16" 8-1/8" 4-1/8"
2 1'4" 8" 1'4-1/8" 8-1/8" 1'4-1/4" 8-1/4"
3 2'0" 1'0" 2'0-3/16" 1'0-3/16" 2'0-3/8" 1'0-3/8"
4 2'8" 1'4" 2'8-1/4" 1'4-1/4" 2'8-1/2" 1'4-1/2"
5 3'4" 1'8" 3'4-5/16" 1'8-5/16" 3'4-5/8" 1'8-5/8"
6 4'0" 2'0" 4'0-3/8" 2'0-3/8" 4'0-3/4" 2'0-3/4"
7 4'8" 2'4" 4'8-7/16" 2'4-7/16" 4'8-7/8" 2'4-7/8"
8 5'4" 2'8" 5'4-1/2" 2'8-1/2" 5'5" 2'9"
9 6'0" 3'0" 6'0-9/16" 3'0-9/16" 6'1-1/8" 3'1-1/8"
10 6'8" 3'4" 6'8-5/8" 3'4-5/8" 6'9-1/4" 3'5-1/4"
15 10'0" 5'0" 10'0-15/16" 5'0-15/16" 10'1-7/8" 5'1-7/8"
20 13'4" 6'8" 13'5-1/4" 6'9-1/4" 13'6-1/2" 6'10-1/2"
25 16'8" 8'4" 16'9-9/16" 8'5-9/16" 16'11-1/8" 8'7-1/8"
30 20'0" 10'0" 20'1-7/8" 10'1-7/8" 20'3-3/4" 10'3-3/4"
35 23'4" 11'8" 23'6-3/16" 11'10-3/16" 23'8-3/8" 12'0-3/8"
40 26'8" 13'4" 26'10-1/2" 13'6-1/2" 27'1" 13'9"
45 30'0" 15'0" 30'2-13/16" 15'2-13/16" 30'5-5/8" 15'5-5/8"
50 33'4" 16'8" 33'7-1/8" 16'11-1/8" 33'10-1/4" 17'2-1/4"
4-57
TABLE 4-58. Block, Brick, and Rubble Masonry
Work Element Description Unit Man-Hours Per Unit
Concrete Block. 12" X 8" X 16" SF 0.167 (3000) 8" X 8" X 16" SF 0.16 (3001) 6" X 8" X 16" SF 0.145 (3002) 4" X 8" X 16" SF 0.118 (3003)
Common Brick. 2-1/4" X 3-3/4" X 8" 8" Thick Wall SF 0.5 (3004) 12" Thick Wall SF 0.7 (3005) 4" Thick Brick Veneer on Frame Walls SF 0.28 (3006)
Mortar Bound Rubble Masonry. 18" to 24" Thick CD 45.0 (3007)
Grouting - Corefill. (High lift or conventional method). CD 16.0 (3008)Reinforced Grouting Brick Work
SUGGESTED CREW SIZE: Eight to ten BUs, depending on size of work area.
NOTES: 1. The masonry estimates are based on the following conditions:(a) All joints are 3/8 inches.(b) Units layed up in running or bond.(c) All mortar mixed by machine.(d) A ratio of three tenders to four masons.
2. For 12" X 12" terra cotta use concrete block table and use 0.9 multiplier3. For glazed concrete block (SPECTOR-GLAZE) or similar) use 1.25 multiplier.4. A ration of 3 tenders for 2 masons.
4-58
TABLE 4-59. Tile Masonry
Work Element Description Unit Man-Hours Per Unit
Ceramic and Quarry Tile.Floors: 1" X 1" Ceramic (paper mounted) SF 0.24 (3009) 3" X 3" Ceramic SF 0.24 (3010) 4" X 4" Quarry SF 0.33 (3011) 6" X 6" Quarry SF 0.265 (3012) 9" X 9" Quarry SF 0.28 (3013)
Base: SF 0.336 (3014)Cap: SF 0.29 (3015)Walls: Ceramic Tile SF 0.44 (3016)
SUGGESTED CREW SIZE: Two to four BUs
NOTES: 1. Tables are based on half of the crew experienced in the work.2. All setting beds being machine made.3. A ration of one helper to one tile setter.4. Cutting tile masonry or tile saw.5. If thin set, using organic adhesive, use 0.75 multiplier.6. Production will be affected by type and scope of work. Large open areas will go faster than smallrooms with many corners. If a crew arrives at a natural stopping point late in the day, hours are lost asthe next phase will not be started until the following day.
4-59
TABLE 4-60. Volume of Grout in Grouted Concrete Block Walls*
Wall Thickness Spacing of Grouted Grout, CD, for Wall Area, SF, for 1(Inches) Cores (Inches) 100 SF Wall Area** CD of Grout**
6 All cores grouted 0.79 12616 0.40 25024 0.28 35732 0.22 45040 0.19 52648 0.17 588
8 All cores grouted 1.26 7916 0.74 13524 0.58 17332 0.49 20440 0.44 22848 0.39 257
12 All cores grouted 1.99 5016 1.18 8524 0.91 11032 0.76 13240 0.70 14348 0.64 156
* Adapted from Volume of Grout Required in Masonry Walls, Design Aid 15, Masonry Institute of America, Los Angeles,Calif., 1971. **A 3-percent allowance has been included for waste and job conditions. All quantities include grout forintermediate and top bond beams in addition to grout for cores.
TABLE 4-61. Maximum Unsupported Heights of CMU Wall During Construction
4-60
TABLE 4-62. Masonry Conversion Units
Material Description Conversion Unit Waste UnitPercentage
Masonry Units.A. 8-inch Blocks: .89 SF per block Full Stretcher 8" X 8" X 16" 10 EA Half Stretcher 8" X 8" X 8" 10 EA Corner Block 8" X 8" X 16" 10 EA Full Jamb 8" X 8" X 16" 10 EA Half Jamp 8' X 8" X 8" 10 EA
B. 6-inch Blocks: .89 SF per block Full Stretcher 6" X 8" X 16" 10 EA Half Stretcher 6" X 8" X 8" 10 EA Corner Block 6" X 8" X 16" 10 EA Full Jamb 6" X 8" X 16" 10 EA Half Jamb 6" X 8" X 8" 10 EA
Mortar Materials.(Includes 20 percent waste)A. Cement, Portland Type I: 1/4-inch Joint .80 CF/100 SF Wall -- BG 3/8-inch Joint 1.10 CF/100 SF Wall -- BG ½2-inch Joint 1.40 CF/100 SF Wall -- BG
B. Lime, Hydrated, Dry Type M: 1/4-inch Joint .60 CF/100 SF Wall -- BG 3/8-inch Joint .81 CF/100 SF Wall -- BG 1/2-inch Joint 1.05 CF/100 SF Wall -- BG
Masonry Wash Materials.(For 1 to 3 Mix and *' X 16" blocks)A. Muriatic Acid 10 LBS/100 SF Surface 10 LBB. Soap, Powdered, Navy Type 2 LBS/100 SF Surface 10 LB
Core Fill Materials.(Conversion units for RST spaced at24" OC)A. Cement,Portlandt Type I: 8- and 6-inch Walls 3 BG/100 SF Wall 10 BG BG 4-inch Walls 2 BG/100 SF Wall 10 BG BG
NOTES: 1. All specials that require field cutting shall be ordered as full size blocks.2. One (1) bag (BG) of lime equals one (1) cubic foot (CF).3. Volume of one cell in an 8" X 8" block is equal to 1/8 CF.4. Seven (7) bags (BG) ofPortlandt Type I cement equals one (1) CD.
4-61
TABLE 4-63. Material Weights and Measures: Masonry
Material Length Width Thickness Weight Weight Weight WeightIN IN IN LBS/ EA LBS/ CF LBS/ CD TONS/
1000
Asbestos 110 to
Brick:Common 8-1/4 4 2-1/2 5.4 2.7 Fire, Std. 9 4-1/2 2-1/2 7.0 3.5 Hard 8-1/2 4-1/4 2-1/4 6.48 3.24Soft 8-1/4 4 2-1/4 4.32 2.6
Cement:Bag 94.0
Clay:Dry 63-95 1,700 to
Fire 130
Wet 120 to 3,200
120
to140
2,295
3,500
2,970
4-62
This page is blank
4-63
DIVISION 5. METALS
Page
A. STRUCTURAL STEELTable 4-64 Structural Steel Fabrication . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-63Table 4-65 Structural Steel Erection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-63Table 4-66 Flame Cutting Structural Steel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-64Table 4-67 Welding Structural Steel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-64
B. STEEL PIPETable 4-68 Install Steel Welded Pipe Lines . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-65
C. MISCELLANEOUS STEELTable 4-69 Gage, Thickness, and Weights of Black and
Galvanized Flat and Corrugated Sheets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-65Table 4-70 Weights of Steel Plates in Pounds per Square Foot . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-66Table 4-71 Weights of Standard Diamond Steel Floor Plates . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-66Table 4-72 Electrode/Wire Requirements for Horizontal Fillet Welding . . . . . . . 4-66Table 4-73 Electrode/Wire Requirements for "V" Groove Butt Joints. . . . . . . . . 4-67Table 4-74 Electrode/Wire Requirements for Square Groove Butt Joints . . . . . . . 4-67Table 4-75 Weights of Flat Steel Bars in LBS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-68Table 4-76 Weights of Square and Round Bars in LBS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-69Table 4-77 Weights of Standard Channels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-70Table 4-78 Weights of Steel Angles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-71
D. BOLTED STEEL TANKSTable 4-79 Bolted Steel Tanks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-72
4-64
This page is blank
4-65
TABLE 4-64. Structural Steel Fabrication
Work Element Description Unit Man-HoursPer Unit
FABRICATE: Structural Frames Ton 16.0 (4001) Columns Ton 16.0 (4002) Girders Ton 16.0 (4003) Beams Ton 10.4 (4004) Trusses Ton 8.0 (4005) Purlins: Girts and Struts Ton 12.8 (4006) Frames for Openings Ton 2.8 (4007) Stairs Ton 28.0 (4008) Platforms Ton 36.0 (4009) Railings (simple tube pipe) FT 1.6 (4010)
SUGGESTED CREW SIZE: Two to six SWs, depending on weight and length of materials
NOTES: 1. Fabrication of structural steel includes cutting, riveting, burning, drilling, milling, fitting,assembling, welding, bolting, storing loading, and hauling to the job site.2. Man-hour units are based on bolted connection. If sections are to be welded use 1.25 multiplier forwelded joint preparation.
TABLE 4-65. Structural Steel Erection
Work Element Description Unit Man-HoursPer Unit
UNLOAD, ERECT, PLUMB Columns Ton 13.6 (4011) Beams Ton 13.6 (4012) Girders Ton 9.0 (4013) Trusses Ton 17.0 (4014) Girts and Purlins Ton 11.9 (4015) Bracing and Tiers Ton 17.9 (4016) Light Framing Ton 23.8 (4017)High strength bolting Bolt .075 (4018)Grating SF 0.192 (4019)
SUGGESTED CREW SIZE: Six SWs (erecting, connecting, plumbing)
NOTES: 1. Erection of structural steel includes handling, erecting, temporary bolting, plumbing, leveling, highstrength bolting, and/or welding.2. Man-hour figures are based on using new construction materials.3. For shop and field painting, see Division 9, table 4-112.
4-66
TABLE 4-66. Flame Cutting Structural Steel
Work Element Description Man-Hours per 1 Foot
1/8 inch 3/16 inch 1/4 inch
5/16 inch 3/8 inch
7/16 inch ½ inch
9/16 inch 5/8 inch 3/4 inch 7/8 inch1 inch
1-1/8 inch1-1/4 inch1-1/2 inch
0.19 (4020)0.2 (4021)
0.23 (4022)0.23 (4023)0.24 (4024)0.27 (4025)0.27 (4026)0.28 (4027)0.3 (4028)0.3 (4029)0.4 (4030)
0.42 (4031)0.44 (4032)0.49 (4033)0.57 (4034)
TABLE 4-67. Welding Structural Steel
(per foot material thickness in man hours)
Horizontal Vertical Overhead
FILET ARC WELDING 1/8 inch 0.15 (4035) 0.27 (4036) 0.36 (4037) 3/16 inch 0.37 (4038) 0.36 (4039) 0.42 (4040) 1/4 inch 0.45 (4041) 0.49 (4042) 0.53 (4043) 5/16 inch 0.49 (4044) 0.69 (4045) 0.93 (4046) 3/8 inch 0.76 (4047) 0.93 (4048) 1.10 (4049) ½ inch 1.05 (4050) 1.10 (4051) 1.40 (4052) 3/4 inch 2.06 (4053) 1.90 (4054) 2.30 (4055) 1 inch 2.40 (4056) 2.30 (4057) 2.60 (4058)
BUTT WELDING 1/8 inch 0.53 (4059) 0.55 (4060) 0.61 (4061) 3/16 inch 0.76 (4062) 0.63 (4063) 0.79 (4064) 1/4 inch 0.87 (4065) 0.73 (4066) 0.93 (4067) 5/16 inch 1.05 (4068) 0.93 (4069) 1.10 (4070) 3/8 inch 1.90 (4071) 1.50 (4072) 2.30 (4073) ½ inch 2.06 (4074) 1.70 (4075) 2.50 (4076) 3/4 inch 3.40 (4077) 2.80 (4078) 3.70 (4079) 1 inch 3.70 (4080) 3.40 (4081) 4.30 (4082)
4-67
TABLE 4-68. Install Steel Welded Pipe Lines
Work Element Description Unit Man-HoursPer Unit
SCHEDULE 40. PIPE AND FITTINGS 1 inch per joint 1.00 (4083) 2 inch per joint 1.48 (4084) 4 inch per joint 2.90 (4085) 6 inch per joint 4.22 (4086) 8 inch per joint 5.67 (4087) 10 inch per joint 7.32 (4088) 12 inch per joint 8.76 (4089) 14 inch per joint 10.91 (4090) 16 inch per joint 12.69 (4091) 18 inch per joint 14.85 (4092) 20 inch per joint 17.08 (4093) 24 inch per joint 18.98 (4094)
SUGGESTED CREW SIZE: Two to four SWs
NOTE: 1. Butt weld to include cut, fit, and install.2. For Schedule 80, use 1.6 multiplier.
TABLE 4-69. Gage, Thickness, and Weight of Black and Galvanized Flat and Corrugated Sheets
Black Galvanized
Weight LB per SF Weight LB per SF
U.S. Thickness Flat Corrugated Thickness Flat CorrugatedGage
12 0.1046 4.3 4.7 5.0 0.1084 4.5 4.9 5.214 0.0747 3.1 3.4 3.6 0.0785 3.2 3.5 3.7
16 0.0598 2.5 2.7 2.8 0.0635 2.6 2.9 3.018 0.0478 2.0 2.1 2.3 0.0516 2.1 2.3 2.4
20 0.0359 1.5 1.6 1.7 0.0396 1.6 1.8 1.922 0.0299 1.2 1.3 1.4 0.0336 1.4 1.5 1.6
24 0.0239 1.0 1.0 1.1 0.0276 1.1 1.2 1.326 0.0179 0.75 0.8 0.8 0.0217 0.91 0.9 1.0
28 0.0149 0.6 0.6 0.7 0.0187 0.7 0.8 0.829 0.0135 0.5 0.6 0.6 0.0172 0.7 0.7 0.8
Corrugations, IN 2-2/3 X ½ 3 X 3//4 Corrugations, IN 2-2/3 X 3 X½ 1/4
4-68
TABLE 4-70. Weights of Steel Plates in Pounds Per Square Foot
Thickness Steel - Estimating Thickness Steel - Estimating
3/16 7.6 3/4 30.61/4 10.2 7/8 35.7
5/16 12.7 1 40.83/8 15.3 1-1/4 51.0
7/16 17.8 1-1/2 61.2½ 20.4 1-3/4 71.45/8 25.5 2 81.6
TABLE 4-71. Weights of Standard Diamond Steel Floor Plates
Thickness Weight per SF Thickness Weight per SFInches Pounds Inches Pounds
1/8 8.0 5/16 13.73/16 8.7 3/8 16.21/4 11.2 ½ 21.5
TABLE 4-72. Electrode/Wire Requirements for Horizontal Fillet Weld
Size of Fillet LBS of Stick Electrode LBS of Wire Electrode(in inches) Required per FT of Weld Required per FT of Weld
(approx.) (approx.)
1/8 0.04 0.023/16 0.11 0.061/4 0.18 0.105/16 0.29 0.163/8 0.42 0.23½ 0.76 0.42
5/8 1.18 0.663/4 1.70 0.951 3.03 1.69
4-69
TABLE 4-73. Electrode/Wire Requirements for "V" Groove Butt Joint
Joint LBS of Stick Electrode LBS of Wire ElectrodeDimensions Required per FT of Weld Required per FT of Weld(In inches) (Approx.) (Approx.)
T B G Without With Without WithReinforcement Reinforcemen Reinforcement Reinforcement
t
1/4 .207 1/16 0.1 0.2 0.80 0.145/16 .311 3/32 0.3 0.4 0.17 0.253/8 .414 1/8 0.5 0.7 0.28 0.39½ .558 1/8 0.8 1.1 0.48 0.64
5/8 .702 1/8 1.3 1.6 0.75 0.943/4 .847 1/8 1.9 2.3 1.08 1.321 1138 1/8 3.4 4.0 1.93 2.24
TABLE 4-74. Electrode/Wire Requirements for Square Groove Butt Joints
Joint LBS of Stick Electrode LBS of Wire ElectrodeDimensions Required per FT of Weld Required per FT of Weld(In inches) (Approx.) (Approx.)
T B G Without With Without WithReinforcement Reinforcement Reinforcement Reinforcement
3/16 3/8 0 ____ .16 ____ .08
1/4 7/16 1/16 .05 .23 .02 .12
5/16 ½ 1/16 .06 .27 .03 .15
1/16 .04 .20 .02 .10
3/32 .07 .26 .03 .14
3/32 .09 .30 .05 .17
4-70
TABLE. 4-75. Weights of Flat Steel Bars 1-Foot Long in LBS
Width of Bars
Thickness 1 inches 2 inches 3 inches 4 inches 5 inches 6 inchesin inches
3/16 .638 1.28 1.91 2.55 3.19 3.831/4 .850 1.70 2.55 3.40 4.25 5.105/16 1.06 2.12 3.19 4.25 5.31 6.383/8 1.28 2.55 3.83 5.10 6.38 7.657/16 1.49 2.98 4.46 5.95 7.44 8.95½ 1.70 3.40 5.10 6.80 8.50 10.20
9/16 1.92 3.83 5.74 7.65 9.57 11.485/8 2.12 4.25 6.38 8.50 10.63 12.75
11/16 2.34 4.67 7.02 9.35 11.69 14.033/4 2.55 5.10 7.65 10.20 12.75 15.30
13/16 2.76 5.53 8.29 11.05 13.81 16.587/8 2.98 5.95 8.93 11.90 14.87 17.85
15/16 3.19 6.38 9.57 12.75 15.94 19.131 3.40 6.80 10.20 13.60 17.00 20.40
1-1/16 3.61 7.22 10.84 14.45 18.06 21.681-1/8 3.83 7.65 11.48 15.30 19.13 22.95
1-3/16 4.04 8.08 12.12 16.15 20.19 24.231-1/4 4.25 8.50 12.75 17.00 21.25 25.50
1-5/16 4.46 8.93 13.39 17.85 22.32 26.781-3/8 4.67 9.35 14.03 18.70 23.38 28.05
1-7/16 4.89 9.78 14.66 19.55 24.44 29.331-1/2 5.10 10.20 15.30 20.40 25.50 30.60
1-9/16 5.32 10.63 15.94 21.25 26.57 31.881-5/8 5.52 11.05 16.58 22.10 27.63 33.15
1-11/16 5.74 11.47 17.22 22.95 28.69 34.431-3/4 5.95 11.90 17.85 23.80 29.75 35.70
1-13/16 6.16 12.33 18.49 24.65 30.81 36.981-7/8 6.38 12.75 19.13 25.50 31.87 38.25
1-15/16 6.59 13.18 19.77 26.35 32.94 38.532 6.80 13.60 20.40 27.20 34.00 40.80
4-71
TABLE 4-76. Weights of Square and Round Bars 1-Foot Long in LBS
Thickness Weight of Weight of Thickness Weight of Weight ofor Diameter Square Bar Round Bar or Diameter Square Bar Round Bar
in Inches in Inches
1/4 .21 .16 1-11/16 ---- 7.605/16 .33 .26 1-3/4 10.41 8.183/8 .47 .37 1-13/16 ---- 8.77
7/16 .65 .51 1-7/8 11.95 9.39½ .85 .66 2 13.60 10.68
9/16 1.07 .84 2-1/8 15.35 12.065/8 1.38 1.04 2-1/4 17.21 13.52
11/16 1.60 1.26 2-3/8 ---- 15.063/4 1.91 1.50 2-1/2 21.25 16.69
13/16 2.24 1.76 2-5/8 23.43 18.407/8 2.60 2.04 2-3/4 25.71 20.20
15/16 ---- 2.35 2-7/8 ---- 22.071 3.40 2.67 3 30.60 24.031-1/16 ---- 3.01 3-1/8 ---- 26.081-1/8 4.30 3.38 3-1/4 35.91 28.211-1/4 5.31 4.17 3-3/8 ---- 30.421-5/16 ---- 4.60 3-1/2 41.65 32.711-3/8 6.42 5.05 3-5/8 ---- 35.091-7/16 ---- 5.52 3-3/4 47.81 37.551-1/2 7.65 6.01 4 54.40 42.731-5/8 8.92 7.05
4-72
TABLE 4-77. Weights of Standard Channels
Depth of Weight Thick- Width Depth of Weight Thick- WidthChannels Per Foot ness of of Flange Channels Per Foot ness of of(inches) (pounds) Web (inches) (inches) (pounds) Web Flange
(inches) (inches) (inches)
3 6.00 0.362 1.602 9 20.00 0.452 2.652
4 7.25 0.325 1.725 10 30.00 0.676 3.036
5 9.00 0.330 1.890 20.00 0.382 2.742
6 13.00 0440 2.160 12 30.00 0.513 3.173
7 14.75 0.423 2.303 15 50.00 0.720 3.720
8 18.75 0.490 2.530
5.00 0.264 1.504 15.00 0.288 2.488 4.10 0.170 1.410 13.40 0.230 2.430
5.40 0.180 1.580 25.00 0.529 2.889
6.70 0.190 1.750 15.30 0.240 2.600
10.50 0.318 2.038 25.00 0.390 3.050 8.20 0.200 1.920 20.70 0.280 2.940
12.25 0.318 2.198 40.00 0.524 3.524 9.80 0.210 2.090 33.90 0.400 3.400
13.75 0.307 2.34711.50 0.220 2.260
4-73
TABLE 4-78. Weights of Steel Angles
Size in Inches Weight Size in Inches Weight Size in Inches Weightper FT per FT per FT
LB LB LB
3 x 2 x 1/4 4.1 4 x 3 x 5/8 13.6 6 x 3-1/2 x 5/16 9.83 x 2 x 5/16 5.0 4 x 3 x 3/4 16.0 6 x 3-1/2 x 3/8 11.73 x 2 x 3/8 5.9 6 x 3-1/2 x 7/16 13.5
3 x 2-1/2 x 1/4 4.5 4 x 3-1/2 x 5/16 7.7 6 x 3-1/2 x 5/8 18.93 x 2-1/2 x 5/16 5.6 4 x 3-1/2 x 3/8 9.13 x 2-1/2 x 3/8 6.6 4 x 3-1/2 x 7/16 10.6 6 x 4 x 5/16 10.33 x 2-1/2 x ½ 8.5 4 x 3-1/2 x ½ 11.9 6 x 4 x 3/8 12.3
3 x 3 x 1/4 4.9 4 x 4 x 1/4 6.6 6 x 4 x ½ 16.23 x 3 x 5/16 6.1 4 x 4 x 5/16 8.2 6 x 4 x 9/16 18.13 x 3 x 3/8 7.2 4 x 4 x 3/8 9.8 6 x 4 x 5/8 20.03 x 3 x 7/16 8.3 4 x 4 x 7/16 11.3 6 x 4 x 3/4 23.63 x 3 x ½ 9.4 4 x 4 x ½ 12.8 6 x 4 x 7/8 27.23 x 3 x 5/8 11.5 4 x 4 x 5/8 15.7
3-1/2 x 2-1/2 x 1/4 4.9 6 x 6 x 7/16 17.23-1/2 x 2-1/2 x 5/16 6.1 4-1/2 x 3 x 3/8 9.1 6 x 6 x ½ 19.63-1/2 x 2-1/2 x 3/8 7.2 6 x 6 x 9/16 21.93-1/2 x 2-1/2 x ½ 9.4 5 x 3 x 5/16 8.2 6 x 6 x 5/8 24.23-1/2 x 2-1/2 x 5/8 11.5 5 x 3 x 3/8 9.8 6 x 6 x 3/4 28.7
3-1/2 x 3 x 1/4 5.4 5 x 3 x ½ 12.8 6 x 6 x 1 37.43-1/2 x 3 x 5/16 6.6 5 x 3 x 3/4 18.53-1/2 x 3 x 3/8 7.9 7 x 3-1/2 x 3/8 13.03-1/2 x 3 x ½ 10.2 5 x 3-1/2 x 5/16 8.7 7 x 3-1/2 x 7/16 15.0
3-1/2 x 3-1/2 x 1/4 5.8 5 x 3-1/2 x 7/16 12.0 7 x 3-1/2 x 5/8 21.03-1/2 x 3-1/2 x 5/16 7.2 5 x 3-1/2 x ½ 13.63-1/2 x 3-1/2 x 3/8 8.5 5 x 3-1/2 x 5/8 16.8 8 x 3-1/2 x ½ 18.73-1/2 x 3-1/2 x 7/16 9.83-1/2 x 3-1/2 x ½ 11.1 5 x 4 x 3/8 11.0 8 x 6 x ½ 23.03-1/2 x 3-1/2 x 5/8 13.6 5 x 4 x ½ 14.5 8 x 6 x 3/4 33.8
4 x 3 x 1/4 5.8 5 x 5 x 3/8 12.3 8 x 3 x ½ 26.44 x 3 x 5/16 7.2 5 x 5 x 7/16 14.3 8 x 3 x 5/8 32.74 x 3 x 3/8 8.5 5 x 5 x ½ 16.2 8 x 3 x 3/4 38.94 x 3 x 7/16 9.8 5 x 5 x 5/8 20.0 8 x 3 x 7/8 45.04 x 3 x ½ 11.1 5 x 5 x 3/4 23.6 8 x 3 x 1 51.0
4 x 3-1/2 x 1/4 6.2 6 x 3-1/2 x ½ 15.3
4 x 4 x 3/4 18.5 6 x 6 x 3/8 14.9
5 x 3 x 7/16 11.3 6 x 6 x 7/8 33.1
5 x 3-1/2 x 3/8 10.4 7 x 3-1/2 x ½ 17.0
8 x 3 x 11/8 56.9
6 x 4 x 7/16 14.3
4-74
TABLE 4-79. Bolted Steel Tanks
Estimated Time for Tank Erection
Work Element Description Unit Man-HoursPer Unit
100 BBL tank EA 55 (4101) 250 BBL tank EA 130 (4102) 500 BBL tank EA 220 (4103) 1,000 BBL tank EA 440 (4104) 3,000 BBL tank EA 750 (4105)
10,000 BBL tank EA 1,600 (4106)50,000 BBL tank EA 6,660 (4107)
SUGGESTED CREW SIZE: 6 to 16 SWs
NOTE: 1. Basis: Tank erection only. Does not include site preparation or uncrating.
4-75
DIVISION 6. CARPENTRY Page
A. ROUGH CARPENTRYTable 4-80 Rough Carpentry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-75Table 4-81 Sheathing and Siding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-76Table 4-82 Number of Wood Joists Required for Any Floor Spacing . . . . . . . . . 4-77Table 4-83 Board Feet of Lumber Required per 100 Square Feet of Surface . . . . 4-78Table 4-84 Material Required for Built-Up Girders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-78Table 4-85 Board Feet Content . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-79Table 4-86 Board Feet Required for Wood Partitions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-80Table 4-87 Number of Studs Required for Variable Spacing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-80Table 4-88 Material Required for Rafters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-81Table 4-89 Roof Areas of Pitched Roofs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-82Table 4-90 Criteria for Plywood Roof Sheathing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-82Table 4-91 Criteria for Plywood Flooring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-83Table 4-92 Finish Carpentry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-84Table 4-93 Wire Nails: Length, and Approximate Number per Pound . . . . . . . . 4-84
4-76
This page is blank
4-77
TABLE 4-80. Rough Carpentry
Work Element Description Unit Man-Hours Per Unit
Floor Joists; Sills; Girders and Blocking BF 0.04 (5001)
Wall Framing-Studs; Plates and Bracing BF 0.04 (5002)
Ceiling Joists BF 0.05 (5003)
Roof Framing (pitch type); Eave Blocking BF 0.06 (5004)Roof Framing (flat type) BF 0.04 (5005)
Beams (shaped and dapped) BF 0.13 (5006)Beams (exposed framing) BF 0.10 (5007)
Trusses, Light (nailed) BF 0.07 (5008)Trusses, Heavy (bolted) BF 0.10 (5009)
Cross Bridging, 2" X 3 " SET 0.16 (5010)
Metal Studs SF of Wall Surface 0.01 (5011)
Fabricate and Install Rough Door Bucks Each Opening 3.0 (5012)(masonry walls)
Ceiling Stripping FT 0.03 (5013)
Furring on Concrete and Masonry Walls FT 0.035 (4014)
Wood Plaster Grounds on Masonry Walls FT 0.06 (5015)
Wood Fences SF 0.08 (5016)
SUGGESTED CREW SIZE: Framing: Four BUs working in pairs; Two BUs cuttingmaterials.
Miscellaneous: Two BUs performing various jobs.
NOTES: 1. Rough carpentry includes measuring, cutting, and installing wood framing, floor joists, sills, crossbridging, wall framing, plates, door bucks, roof framing, and rafters, install wall and roof sheathing,and siding.
2. Wall framing studs, plates and bracing, window and door headers.
3. Metal studs more than 18 GS use 1.2 multiplier.
4-78
TABLE 4-81. Sheathing and Siding
Work Element Description Unit Man-HourPer Unit
Roof Sheathing: BF 0.04 (5017) 1" X 6" and 1" X 8" Boards 2" T&G Laid Straight (Add 20 percent for diagonal)
Plywood SF 0.025 (5018)
Wall Sheathing: SF 0.03 (5019) 1" X 6" and 1" X 8" Boards 2" T&G Laid Straight (Use 1.2 multiplier for diagonal)
Plywood SF 0.025 (5020)
Siding: Wood Shingles SF 0.07 (5021) Board and Batten SF 0.05 (5022) Shiplap, Drop Siding SF 0.05 (5023) Plywood SF 0.04 (5024)
SUGGESTED CREW SIZE: Sheathing: Four BUS working in pairs placing materials; Two BUS cutting; Two BUS handling materials.
NOTE: 1. Siding includes building paper.
4-79
TABLE 4-82. Number of Wood Joists Required for Any Floor and Spacing
Spacing of Joists (Inches)
Length of Span 12 Inches 16 Inches 24 Inches(Feet)
6 7 6 47 8 6 58 9 7 59 10 8 610 11 9 611 12 9 712 13 10 713 14 11 814 15 12 815 16 12 916 17 13 917 18 14 1018 19 15 1019 20 15 1120 21 16 1121 22 17 1222 23 18 1223 24 18 1324 25 19 1325 26 20 1426 27 21 1427 28 21 1528 29 22 1529 30 23 1630 31 24 1631 32 24 1732 33 25 1733 34 26 1834 36 27 1835 36 27 1940 41 31 21
4-80
TABLE 4-83. Board Feet of Lumber Required Per 100 Square Feet of Surface
When used for Studs, joists, rafters, wall and floor furring strips, etc.
Board Feet Required Per 100 SF of Surface
Lumber Size (Inches) On 12-Inch On 16-Inch On 24-Inch CentersCenters Centers
1 X 2 16-2/3 12-1/2 8-1/32 X 2 33-1/3 25 16-2/32 X 4 66-2/3 50 33-1/32 X 6 100 75 50 2 X 8 133-1/3 100 66-2/3
2 X 10 166-2/3 125 83-1/3 2 X 12 200 150 100 3 X 6 150 112-1/2 75 3 X 8 200 133-1/3 100
3 X 10 250 187-1/2 125 3 X 12 300 225 150
NOTE: 1. Data in this table does not include any allowance for waste in cutting, extra joists at the end of eachspan, doubling joists under or around stiarwells, top or bottom plates, etc. These items vary with eachjob and must be added as required.
TABLE 4-84. Material Required for Built-Up Girders
Size of Girder (Inches) Board FT Required Nails Requiredper 1,000 BF
4 X 6 2.15 534 X 8 2.85 40
4 X 10 3.58 32 4 X 12 4.28 266 X 6 3.21 436 X 8 4.28 32
6 X 10 5.35 26 6 X 12 6.42 228 X 8 5.71 30
8 X 10 7.13 24 8 X 12 8.56 20
4-81
TABLE 4-85. Board Feet Content
Length in Feet
Size in 8 10 12 14 16 18 20 22 24Inches
1 X 2 1-1/3 1-2/3 2 2-1/3 2-2/3 3 3-1/3 3-2/3 41 X 4 2-2/3 3-1/3 4 4-2/3 5-1/3 6 6-2/3 7-1/3 81 X 6 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 121 X 8 5-1/3 6-2/3 8 9-1/3 10-2/3 12 13-1/3 14-2/3 161 X 10 6-2/3 8-1/3 10 11-2/3 13-1/3 15 16-2/3 18-1/3 201 X 12 8 10 12 4 16 18 20 22 245/4 X 4 3-1/3 4-1/6 5 5-5/6 6-2/3 7-1/2 8-1/3 9-1/6 105/4 X 6 5 6-1/4 7-1/2 8-3/4 10 11-1/4 12-1/2 13-3/4 152 X 4 5-1/3 6-2/3 8 9-1/3 10-2/3 12 13-1/3 14-2/3 162 X 6 8 10 12 14 16 18 20 22 242 X 8 10-2/3 13-1/3 16 18-2/3 21-1/3 24 26-2/3 29-1/3 322 X 10 13-1/3 16-2/3 20 23-1/3 26-2/3 30 33-1/3 36-2/3 402 X 12 16 20 24 28 32 36 40 44 483 X 4 8 10 12 14 16 18 20 22 243 X 6 12 15 18 21 24 27 30 33 363 X 8 16 20 24 28 32 36 40 44 483 X 10 20 25 30 35 40 45 50 55 603 X 12 24 30 36 42 48 54 60 66 723 X 14 28 35 42 49 56 63 70 77 843 X 16 32 40 48 56 64 72 80 88 964 X 4 10-2/3 13-1/3 16 18-2/3 21-1/3 24 26-2/3 29-1/3 324 X 6 16 20 24 28 32 36 40 44 484 X 8 21-1/3 26-2/3 32 37-1/3 42-2/3 48 53-1/3 58-2/3 644 X 10 26-2/3 33-1/3 40 46-2/3 53-1/3 60 66-2/3 73-1/3 804 X 12 32 40 48 56 64 72 80 88 964 X 14 37-1/3 46-2/3 56 65-1/3 74-2/3 84 93-1/3 102-2/3 1124 X 16 42-2/3 53-1/3 64 74-2/3 85-1/3 96 106-2/3 117-1/3 1286 X 6 24 30 36 42 48 54 60 66 726 X 8 32 40 48 56 64 72 80 88 966 X 10 40 50 60 70 80 90 100 110 1206 X 12 48 60 72 84 96 108 120 132 1446 X 14 56 70 84 98 112 126 140 154 1686 X 16 64 80 96 112 128 144 160 176 1928 X 8 42-2/3 53-1/3 64 74-2/3 85-1/3 96 106-2/3 117-1/3 1288 X 10 53-1/3 66-2/3 80 93-1/3 106-2/3 120 133-1/3 146-2/3 1608 X 12 64 80 96 112 128 144 160 176 192
4-82
TABLE 4-86. Board Feet Required for Wood Partitions 2-inch by 4-inch Studs 16 inches on Centers
with Single Top and Bottom Plates
Height of Partition
Length of No. Studs 8 FT 0 IN 10 FT 0 IN 12 FT 0 INPartition Required
3'0" 3 20 24 28 4'0" 4 27 32 37 5'0" 5 33 40 47 6'0" 6 40 48 56 7'0" 6 41 49 57 8'0" 7 48 57 67 9'0" 8 55 65 7610'0" 9 61 73 8511'0" 9 63 75 8712'0" 10 69 83 9613'0" 11 76 91 10514'0" 12 83 99 11515'0" 12 84 100 11616'0" 13 91 108 12517'0" 14 97 116 13518'0" 15 104 124 14419'0" 15 105 125 14520'0" 16 112 133 155
NOTES: 1. Includes top and bottom plates.2. Add 2/3 foot of lumber BM for each foot of double top or bottom plate.
TABLE 4-87. Number of Studs for Required for Variable Spacing(Partition, Floor Joist, and Ceiling Joist)
Distance on Center Multiply Length of Partition Add(Inches) BY
12 1.0 116 0.75 124 0.50 1
NOTE: 1. Add for top and bottom plates on stud walls.
4-83
TABLE 4-88. Material Required for Rafters
Center-To-Center Spacing of Rafters
Board Feet Required per 100 SF of Area
Rafter Size 12 Inches 16 Inches 24 Inches LBS of Nails(Inches) Required per
1000 BF
2 X 4 89 71 53 172 X 6 129 102 75 122 X 8 171 134 112 92 X 10 212 167 121 72 X 12 252 197 143 6
Lengths of Common, Hip, and Valley Rafters per 12 Inches of Run
1 2 3 4Rise and Run Length in Inches Length in Inches
or Cut Common Rafter Hip or Valleyper 12" of Run Rafters Conversion Factor
2 and 12 12.165 17.088 1.014 3 and 12 12.369 17.233 1.031 4 and 12 12.649 17.433 1.054 5 and 12 13.000 17.692 1.083 6 and 12 13.417 18.000 1.118
7 and 12 13.892 18.358 1.158 8 and 12 14.422 18.762 1.202 9 and 12 15.000 19.209 1.25010 and 12 15.620 19.698 1.30211 and 12 16.279 20.224 1.35712 and 12 16.971 20.785 1.413
13 and 12 17.692 21.378 1.47414 and 12 18.439 22.000 1.53715 and 12 19.210 22.649 1.60116 and 12 20.000 23.324 1.66717 and 12 20.809 24.021 1.73418 and 12 21.633 24.739 1.803
19 and 12 22.500 25.475 1.87520 and 12 23.375 26.230 1.94821 and 12 24.125 27.000 2.01022 and 12 25.000 27.785 2.08323 and 12 26.000 28.583 2.16724 and 12 26.875 29.394 2.240
NOTES: 1. Includes common rafters, hip and valley rafters, ridge boards and collar beams.2. To obtain the SF of roof area for a given pitch, use the building SF of floor area and multiply it bythe appropriate conversion factor in column 4 (include the overhang).Example: Bld 10' X 10' with 2' overhang on all sides, using 6" and 12" out. 14' X 14' = 196 SF X1.118 = 219.12 SF of roof area.
4-84
TABLE 4-89. Roof Areas of Pitched Roofs
Pitch Increase of Area MultiplicationOver Flat Root Factor
(Percent)
1/4 12 1.121/3 20 1.203/8 25 1.25½ 42 1.42
5/8 60 1.603/4 80 1.807/8 101 2.01
TABLE 4-90. Criteria for Plywood Roof Sheathing
Design Load Factor in LBS PSF* Nail Spacing
Plywood 20 PSF 30 PSF 40 PSF Nail Size Panel Interme-Thickness and Type Edge diate(Inches) (Inches) (Inches)
½ 32 32 30 6d 6 12
5/8 42 42 39 8d 6 12
3/4 48 47 42 8d 6 12
Common
Common
Common
*per square foot
NOTES: 1. Plywood continuous over two or more spans with grain of face ply across supports.2. Provide blocking or other means of suitable edge support when span exceeds 28 inches for ½-inch,32 inches for 5/8-inch, or 36 inches for 3/4-inch plywood.
4-85
TABLE 4-91. Criteria for Plywood Flooring
Nail Spacing
Application Thickness of Max Spacing Nail Size Panel Inter-Plywood of Supports and Type Edge mediate(Inches) CTR to CTR
Subflooring ½ 16d 6d Common 6 105/8 20b 8d Common 6 103/4 24b 8d Common 6 10
Underlayment 3/8 6d Ring-Shank 6 8
5/8 Cement Coated Wayor Each
8d Flathead
NOTES: 1. Provide blocking at panel edge for other than 25 32-inch thick strip flooring.2. If strip flooring is perpendicular to supports, ½-inch thick strip flooring can be used on a 24-inchspan.3. If resilient flooring is to be applied without underlaying, set nails 1/16-inch below surface.4. If supports are not well seasoned, use ring-shank nails.
4-86
TABLE 4-92. Finish Carpentry
Work Element Description Unit Man-HoursPer Unit
Baseboard (two member) FT 0.08 (5026)
Mouldings Chair Rails Ceiling Finish Facias Chalk and Tackboard Trim
FTFTFTFT
0.06 (5027) 0.0 6 (5028) 0.06 (5029)0.08 (5030)
Stairs Cellar Complete 10 FT Rise Back or Enclosed 12 FT Rise Front, Open 12 FT Rise Front, Open Ornate
CompleteCompleteCompleteComplete
10.0 (5031) 24.0 (5032) 54.0 (5033)102.0 (5034)
Shelving, Plywood , or 1" X 12" (Metal Brackets) FT 0.01 (5035)
Closet Unit, Shelf, and Pole Only EA 2.0 (5036)
Soffits, Plywood FT 0.12 (5037)
False Beams (Built-Up) FT 0.18 (5038)
SUGGESTED CREW SIZE: Trim work: two BUS; Cabinets: two BUS;Miscellaneous: two BUS
NOTES: 1. Finish carpentry includes the work of installing baseboard, molding, wooden stairs, closet units,wooden shelving, soffits, and false beams.2. For cornice estimates, use soffit figures.
TABLE 4-93. Wire Nails: Length and Approximate Number Per Pound
Size Length (Inches) Common Finish
2d 3d 4d 5d 6d 7d 8d 9d
10d12d16d20d
1.00 8741.25 5741.50 320 5741.75 2542.00 200 3002.25 1542.50 110 1902.75 903.00 72 1353.25 603.50 484.00 30
4-87
DIVISION 7. MOISTURE PROTECTION
Page
A. WATERPROOFINGTable 4-94 Waterproofing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-87
B. SHEET METAL WORKTable 4-95 Sheet Metal Work . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-88
C. INSULATIONTable 4-96 Insulation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-88Table 4-97 Fastener Requirements for Batts of Insulation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-89Table 4-98 Loose Fill Insulation Requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-89
4-88
This page is blank
4-89
TABLE 4-94. Waterproofing
Work Element Description Unit Man-HoursPer Unit
Built-Up Roofing 3 Ply SF 0.04 (3017) 4 Ply SF 0.05 (3018) 5 Ply SF 0.06 (3019)
Roof Insulation SF 0.06 (3020)
Asphaltic Aluminum Roofing Asphaltic Primer SF 0.015 (3021) Asphaltic Aluminum SF 0.015 (3022)
Shingle Roofing (includes felt paper) Asphalt Shingles SF 0.05 (3023) Wood Shingles SF 0.07 (3024) Asbestos Shingles SF 0.09 (3025)
Corrugated Roofing Corrugated or V-Crimp Metal on Wood Purlins SF 0.035 (3026) on Metal Framing SF 0.07 (3027)
Corrugated Asbestos, Cement on Wood Purlins SF 0.06 (3028) on Metal Framing SF 0.08 (3029)
SUGGESTED CREW SIZE: 4 to 12 BUs
NOTE: 1. All estimates are based on 50 percent experienced crews with good supervision.2. Insulation installation should not exceed that which can be covered with roofing the same day.3. For below grade waterproofing use 0.75 multiplier for figures listed.4. Crew size will be dictated by safety, equipment used, scope of work, and the number of operationsinvolved.
4-90
TABLE 4-95. Sheet Metal Work
Work Element Description Unit Man-HoursPer Unit
Fabrication Roof Gutters FT 0.05 (3030) Down Spouts FT 0.05 (3031) Roof Ridges FT 0.04 (3032) Roof Valleys FT 0.04 (3033) Flashing FT 0.06 (3034)
Installation Roof Gutters FT 0.08 (3035) Down Spouts FT 0.08 (3036) Roof Ridges FT 0.05 (3037) Roof Valleys FT 0.05 (3038) Flashing FT 0.07 (3039)
SUGGESTED CREW SIZE: Three to five SWs
NOTES: 1. Fabrication is usually performed in the sheet metal shop and includes making patterns, cutting,forming, seaming, soldering, attaching stiffeners, and loading for delivery.2. Installation includes unloading, storing on site, handling into place, hanging, fastening, andsoldering.
TABLE 4-96. Insulation
Work Element Description Unit Man-HoursPer Unit
Ceilings and Walls Aluminum Foil; 1- and 2-sided Foil; SF 0.015 (3040) Mineral Wool 2" to 6" Batts; Pouring wool over ceiling at 3-1/2" depth; Fiberglass insulation; Kraft paper faced, and Masonry Fill.
Rigid Insulation Board Walls, Ceilings, and Roofs Perimeter SF 0.02 (3041) Foundation Walls
SUGGESTED CREW SIZE: Two to six BUs
NOTE: 1. The installation of insulation includes scaffolding when required, fastening insulation into place, andcutouts in insulation, as required.
4-91
TABLE 4-97. Fastener Requirements for Batts of Insulation
Size of Batt (Inches) Area of Batt (SF) Number of Batts Number of StaplesRequired Required per 100 SF per 100 SF
15 X 24 2.50 40 16015 X 48 5.00 20 16019 X 24 3.70 32 16019 X 48 6.33 16 16023 X 24 3.84 26 16023 X 48 7.67 13 160
TABLE 4-98. Loose Fill Insulation Requirements
Density of Fill, LB Per CF
6 LB 7 LB 8 LB 9 LB 10 LB
Area in SF Covered per CF of Fill
Thickness ofFill (Inches)
1 21.2 18.0 15.9 14.1 13.02 10.6 9.1 8.0 7.1 6.43 7.1 6.1 5.3 4.7 4.24 5.3 4.6 4.0 3.5 3.2
4-92
This page is blank
4-93
DIVISION 8. DOORS, WINDOWS, AND GLASSPage
A. DOOR INSTALLATION Table 4-99 Door Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-93
B. WINDOW INSTALLATIONTable 4-100 Window Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-94
C. GLASS AND GLAZINGTable 4-101 Glass and Glazing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-94
4-94
This page is blank
4-95
TABLE 4-99. Door Installation
Work Element Description Unit Man-HoursPer Unit
Wood Doors and Frames Door Frames and Trim Single Exterior EA 3 (6001) Double Exterior EA 3 (6002) Single Interior EA 3 (6003) Double Interior EA 4 (6004) Sliding Door Frame EA 4 (6005)
Doors, Fit, Hand, and Lock Single Exterior EA 5 (6006) Double Exterior EA 8 (6007) Single Interior EA 5 (6008) Double Interior EA 7 (6009) Screen Doors EA 2 (6010)
Metal Doors Single EA 6 (6011) Double EA 9 (6012)
Miscellaneous Doors Complete with Trim and Hardware
Rolling, Manual Operated EA 29 (6013) Rolling, Motor Operated EA 36 (6014) Sliding, Manual Operated EA 20 (6015) Sliding, Motor Operated EA 26 (6016) Sliding, Fire EA 19 (6017) Garage Doors Wood 16' X 7' EA 8 (6018) Aluminum 16' X 7' EA 10 (6019) Scuttles EA 10 (6020)
Caulking FT 0.005 (6021)
NOTES: 1. Includes jambs, stops, casings, and weather stripping.2. Does not include sills or thresholds.3. On wood doors, if power planes, hinge butt routers, and lock mortisers are used, use 0.75 multiplieron installation time.
4-96
TABLE 4-100. Window Installation
Work Element Description Unit Man-HoursPer Unit
Wood Windows Double Hung EA 4.0 (6022) Casement, Single EA 4.0 (6023) Fixed, Wood Sash EA 3.0 (6024) Jalouse EA 2.0 (6025) Skylights EA 8.0 (6026)
Metal Windows Casement EA 2.0 (6027) Commercial Projected EA 2.0 (6028) Skylights EA 2.0 (6029) Double Hung EA 9.0 (6030)
Louvers EA 5.0 (6031)
Screens EA 2.0 (6032)
Venetian Blinds EA 2.0 (6033)
Weatherstripping EA 3.0 (6034)
Caulking FT 0.003 (6035)
SUGGESTED CREW SIZE: Two to six BUs
NOTES: 1. Installation includes drilling for fasteners, expansion shields, installing plugs, toggle bolts, blocking,hinges, locks, and other hardware.2. For special panic device for doors add three hours for single, four hours for double doors.
TABLE 4-101. Glass and Glazing
Work Element Description Unit Man-Hours PerUnit
Small Panes 2-FT. Square or Less SF 0.16 (6036)Medium Panes 2- to 6-FT Square SF 0.17 (6037)Large Panes 6- to 10-FT Square SF 0.21 (6038)Plate Glass Store Fronts 200- to 400- FT Square SF 21.0 (6039)
NOTES: 1. Estimates are based on putty set installation: if installed with metal stops and rubber, double theman-hour figures; if vinyl set, snap-on triple man-hour figures; for insulated glass use 0.67 multiplier2. When glazing from outside using scaffolding or swinging staging, one man is required on the groundto support two glaziers; use 1.5 multiplier3. For winter work add use 1.25 multiplier.4. Do not air ship insulated glass units such as Thermopane, Twindow, etc., due to unequalpressurization.
4-97
DIVISION 9. FINISHES Page
A. PLASTER AND STUCCOTable 4-102 Portland Cement, Stucco, and Plaster . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-97Table 4-103 Material Requirements for Cement, Stucco, and Plaster . . . . . . . . . . 4-97
B. ACOUSTICAL TREATMENTTable 4-104 Acoustical Treatment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-97
C. FLOORING AND TILING SOFTTable 4-105 Flooring and Tiling Soft . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-98Table 4-106 Estimating Floor Tile Requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-99Table 4-107 Floor Tile Waste Allowances . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-99Table 4-108 Mastic Requirements for Resilient Flooring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-100
D. WALL COVERINGTable 4-109 Wall Covering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-100Table 4-110 Estimating Ready Mix Joint Compound and Tape . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-101Table 4-111 Estimating Fastener Requirements for Wallboard . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-101
E. PAINTING STRUCTURAL AND MISCELLANEOUS STEELTable 4-112 Painting Structural and Miscellaneous Steel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-102Table 4-113 Fence Metal Painting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-102
F. INTERIOR PAINTINGTable 4-114 Interior Painting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-103
G. EXTERIOR PAINTINGTable 4-115 Drying Times for Finishes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-104Table 4-116 Coverage for Paints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-105Table 4-117 Exterior Painting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-106
4-98
This page is blank
4-99
TABLE 4-102. Portland Cement, Stucco, and Plaster
Work Element Description Unit Man-HoursPer Unit
Three Coats on Interior Masonry Units SY 0.42 (7001)Three Coats on Exterior Masonry Units SY 0.28 (7002)Three Coats on Metal Lath SY 0.62 (7003)Install Metal Lath SY 0.1 (7004)
SUGGESTED CREW SIZE: Four to eight BUs
NOTES: 1. Lathing and plastering includes handing material into place; installing furring strips, metal lath, andmixing plaster; installing and finishing plaster.
TABLE 4-103. Material Requirements for Cement, Stucco, and Plaster
Materials Required per 100 SF of Wall
Mortar: Mixture Mortar: Mixture Ratio 1:2-1/2 Ratio 1:3
Thickness Mortar Cement Sand Cement Sand(Inches) CF Bags CF Bags CF
1/4 2.08 0.84 2.08 0.73 2.203/8 3.13 1.26 3.14 1.10 3.30½ 4.17 1.68 4.19 1.47 4.40
5/8 5.21 2.09 5.23 1.83 5.503/4 6.25 2.51 6.28 2.20 6.601 8.33 3.35 8.37 2.93 8.80
TABLE 4-104. Acoustical Treatment
Work Element Description Unit Man-HoursPer Unit
Acoustical Tile Ceiling Cemented in Place SF 0.028 (7005) Nailed to Furring Strips SF 0.039 (7006)
Suspension System for Ceiling: Includes Ceiling Panels SF 0.042 (7007)Drilling holes in concrete to ecure hangers SF 0.008 (7101)
SUGGESTED CREW SIZE: Two to four BUs working in pairs.
NOTES: 1. Acoustical treatment includes layout, fitting and placing ceiling tile, installing suspended ceilingframework; setting up and moving platform or scaffold along with work.
4-100
TABLE 4-105. Flooring and Tiling Soft
Work Element Description Unit Man- Hours
Per Unit
Subflooring: Plywood BF 0.019 (7008) 1" X 6" and 1" X 8" Laid Straight BF 0.025 (7009) 1" X 6" and 1" X 8" Diagonal BF 0.031 (7010) 2" T&G Laid Straight BF 0.025 (7011) 2" T&G Diagonal BF 0.030 (7012)
Blocking at Plywood Edges BF 0.028 (7013)
Finish Flooring Hardwood Flooring, End Matched, Laid Straight BF 0.063 (7014) Softwood Flooring, Laid Straight BF 0.042 (7015)
Tiling, Soft Tile cemented directly to Floor: SF 0.033 (7016) Asphalt, Rubber, Vinyl, Cork
Tile with Felt Lining SF 0.047 (7017) Linoleum with Felt Lining SF 0.047 (7018)
Carpet Roll, Nail Strip and Padding SF 0.050 (7079) Tile, 12" SF 0.035 (7080) Tile, 24" SF 0.012 (7081)
SUGGESTED CREW SIZE: Flooring Operations: Two BUs laying Flooring; two BUs sawingand handling. Tiling Operations: Two to four BUs, as required.
NOTES: 1. Flooring includes measuring, cutting, and installing Subflooring, finish flooring, and soft tile(asphalt, rubber, vinyl, cork, linoleum); installing building paper under finish floors; adhesive undertile floors; building paper under soft tile when laid over wooden floors.2. Hardwood flooring is estimated on 25/32" x 2-1/4"; Softwood flooring is estimated on 25/32" x3-1/4".
4-101
TABLE 4-106. Estimating Floor Tile Requirements
Tile Size (Inches)
6 X 6 9 X 9 12 X 12
Number of Tiles Required
Area SF INCLUDES WASTE ALLOWANCE
1 4 2 1 2 8 4 2 3 12 6 3 4 16 8 4 5 20 9 5 6 24 11 6 7 28 13 7 8 32 15 8 9 36 16 9
10 40 18 1020 80 36 2030 120 54 3040 160 72 4050 200 89 5060 240 107 6070 280 125 7080 320 143 8090 360 160 90
100 400 178 100200 800 356 200300 1200 534 300400 1600 712 400500 2000 890 500
NOTE: 1. To find the number of the required for an area not shown in this table, such as 9" X 9" tile for 550SF, add the number of tile needed for 50 SF to the number needed for 500 SF. The result is 1,028 tile.
TABLE 4-107. Floor Tile Waste Allowances
Area to be Tiled (SF) Waste Allowance (Percent)
1 to 50 1451 to 100 10
101 to 200 8201 to 500 7501 to 1000 5Over 1000 3
4-102
TABLE 4-108. Mastic Requirements for Resilient Floor
Type of Resilient Flooring Mastic Required GL per 100 SF
Asphalt Tile 0.33Rubber Tile 0.33Plastic Tile 0.76Cork Tile 0.91Linotile 0.91
NOTE: 1. On gallon covers 300 to 400 square feet. Current coverage for today’s products.
TABLE 4-109. Wall Covering
Work Element Description Unit Man-HoursPer Unit
Finish Walls Plywood SF 0.041 (7019) Insulated Plank SF 0.036 (7020) Paneling SF 0.061 (7021)
Gypsum Wallboard ½-Inch Thick (includes Perf Tape System) Applied on Wall Studs (Wood) SF 0.033 (7022) Applied on Ceiling Joists (Wood) SF 0.039 (7023)
SUGGESTED CREW SIZE: Four to six BUs working in pairs
NOTES: 1. Wall covering includes measuring, cutting, and installing plywood, insulated plank, paneling, andgypsum wallboard.2. Estimate is based on installing wall covering only with nails or an adhesive, if any furring nailingstrips, special joining, or fasteners are included, allow extra time.3. Thin-type paneling should have substantial backing of gypsum board, plaster, or plywood. Insidecorners and ceilings can be scribed to fit.4. Gypsum wallboard perforated joint system man-hour estimate is based on two applications.
4-103
TABLE 4-110. Estimating Ready Mix Joint Compound and Tape
Gypsum Wallboard Estimated Amount of Estimated Amount of (SF) Ready Mix Joint Compound Wallboard Tape
100-200 1 GL Two 60 FT Rolls300-400 2 GL Three 60 FT Rolls500-600 3 GL One 250 FT Roll700-800 4 GL One 60 FT. Roll
900-1000 1-5 GL Pail One 250 FT Roll Two 60 FT Rolls One 500 FT Roll
NOTES: 1. In the adhesive and nail-on method, gypsum board adhesive is applied to the joists and studs beforeeach piece of wallboard is positioned and mailed. The adhesive is applied to the framing member from acaulking gum in about 3/8-inch diameter bead. For each 1000 SF of wallboard use eight quart size tubesof adhesive.2. Using your sketch, determine the lengths and number of boards required. Nails can be estimatedfrom table 4-95.
TABLE 4-111. Estimating Fastener Requirements for Wallboard
Type of Wall Board Size of Panels Fastening Method Amount of(Inches) Adhesive
(in GL) or Nails (in LB) required
per 100 SF
Gypsum 48 X 96 Nailed to Studs 1.00 LB Perforated Hardboard 48 X 96 Nailed to Studs 4.00 LBPlant T&G Board 8 X 96 Nailed to Studs 2.00 LBPlant T&G Board 12 X 96 Nailed to Studs 2.00 LBPlywood Panels 48 X 96 Nailed to Studs or Wall 1.25 LBRock Lath 16 X 96 Nailed to Studs 5.00 LBTempered Tileboard 48 X 48 Nailed to Studs 1.00 LB Tempered Tileboard 48 X 48 Adhesive Applied to Wall 1.50 GL
4-104
TABLE 4-112. Painting Structural and Miscellaneous Steel
Work Element Description Unit Man-HoursPer Unit
Structural Steel, per coat Brush TN 3.0 (7024) Spray TN 2.0 (7025) Wire Brush Clean TN 4.0 (7026) Sandblasting TN 6.0 (7027)
Miscellaneous Iron and Steel, per coat Brush TN 5.0 (7028) Wire Brush Clean TN 5.0 (7029)
SUGGESTED CREW SIZE: Brush Painting: four to eight men. Spray Painting: One totwo men spraying, one or two tending
NOTE: 1. Structural steel painting includes removing rust, scale, oil, grease, and dirt; mixing and applyingpaint; sanding between coats when required.2. For wire brush cleaning and sandblasting see table 101.
TABLE 4-113. Fence Metal Painting
Work Element Description Unit Man-HoursPer Unit
Fence Posts 2.5 inches to 3.5 inches diameter FT 0.021 (7030) 4.0 inches to 5.0 inches diameter FT 0.03 (7031) 6.0 inches diameter FT 0.033 (7032)
Paint Fence Fabric with Roller and Brush SF 0.015 (7033)
NOTE: 1. Fence metal painting includes removing rust, scale, oil, grease, and dirt; mixing, and applyingpaint.
4-105
TABLE 4-114. Interior Painting
Work Element Description Unit Man-HoursPer Unit
Brush Painting, per coat Wood Flat Work SF 0.011 (7034) Doors and Windows Area SF 0.012 (7035) Trim SF 0.009 (7036) Plaster, Sand Finish SF 0.01 (7037) Plaster, Smooth Finish SF 0.01 (7038) Plasterboard SF 0.008 (7039) Masonry SF 0.012 (7040) Metal SF 0.012 (7041) Varnish Flat Work SF 0.009 (7042) Enamel Flat Work SF 0.007 (7043) Enamel Trim SF 0.013 (7044)
Roller Painting, per coat Wood Flat Work SF 0.007 (7045) Doors SF 0.009 (7046) Plaster, Sand Finish SF 0.004 (7047) Plaster, Smooth Finish SF 0.005 (7048) Plasterboard SF 0.005 (7049) Masonry SF 0.005 (7050) Metal SF 0.007 (7051)
Spray Painting, per coat Wood Flat Work SF 0.004 (7052) Plaster, Plasterboard SF 0.004 (7053) Masonry SF 0.004 (7054) Metal SF 0.005 (7055)
Taping, Flushing Joints, FT 0.054 (7056)Sanding Plasterboard of Joint
Sanding Wood Floors SF 0.012 (7057)Finish Wood Floors Sealer and One Finish Coat SF 0.021 (7058)
NOTE: 1. The painting of interior surfaces includes surface preparation, mixing paint materials, and application of paint to surface.
4-106
TABLE 4-115. Drying Times For Finishes
Material Tough Recoat Rub
Lacquer 1 to 10 min. 1.5 to 3 hours 16-24 hoursLacquer Sealer 1 to 10 min. 30-45 min. 1 hour (sand)Paste Wood Filler ---- 24-48 hours ----Paste Wood Filler (Quick Dry) ---- 3-4 hours ----Water Stain 1 hour 12 hours ----Oil Stain 1 hour 24 hours ----Spirit Stain zero 10 min. ----Shading Stain zero zero ----Non-Grain Raising Stain 15 min. 3 hours ----NGR Stain (Quick Dry) 2 min. 15 min. ----Pigment Oil Stain 1 hour 12 hours ----Pigment Oil Stain (Quick Dry) 1 hour 3 hours ----Shellac 15 min. 2 hours 12-18 hoursShellac (Wash Coat) 2 min. 30 min. ----Varnish 1 hour 30 min. 18-24 hours 24-48 hoursVarnish (Quick Dry, Synthetic) 30 min. 4 hours 12-24 hours
Average Drying Time: Different products will vary.
4-107
TABLE 4-116. Coverage for Paints
Square Feet to Gallon
Material 1 Coat 2 Coats 3 Coats
Enamels 500 250 195
Flat Wall Paint: White/light 575 290 215colors on smooth finish
Flat Wall Paint: Dark colors on 725 365 240rough sand finish
Inside Floor Paint 500 275 ----
Outside House Paint: 475 255 190White/light tints, porous woods
Outside House Paint; 525 275 190White/light tints, close grainedwoods
Outside House Paint: Dark 525 280 215colors, grey, tan, porous grainedwoods
Outside House Paint: Dark 575 300 215colors, grey, ten, close grainedwoods
Stain: Wood tints 500 ---- ----
Refer to manufacturers' specifications and coverage figure.
4-108
TABLE 4-117. Exterior Painting
Work Element Description Unit Man-HoursPer Unit
Brush Painting, per coat Masonry SF 0.012 (7059) Metal, Flat SF 0.012 (7060) Metal Roofing and Siding FT 0.01 (7061) Steel Sash, area of opening SF 0.009 (7062) Trim SF 0.011 (7063) Wood Siding SF 0.012 (7064) Wood Doors and Windows, area of opening SF 0.012 (7065)
Roller Painting, per coat Doors SF 0.009 (7066) Masonry SF 0.01 (7067) Metal, Flat SF 0.009 (7068)
Spray Painting, per coat Airfield Lines and Numbers, including Glass Beads SF 0.014 (7069) Doors SF 0.009 (7070) Masonry SF 0.008 (7071) Metal, Flat SF 0.007 (7072) Metal Roofing and Siding SF 0.008 (7073) Wood Siding SF 0.005 (7074)
Cementitious Paint, including curing SF 0.016 (7075)
Sandblasting Steel SF 0.066 (7076)
Wirebrush Cleaning of Steel SF 0.038 (7077)
Waterproofing on Masonry: clean and spray SF 0.014 (7078)
SUGGESTED CREW SIZE: One to five men spraying; one to five men tending (one man is usedto mix and prepare paint for larger crews). Sandblasting crew aminimum of four.
NOTES: 1. Surface preparation for exterior painting includes removing mill scale from metal surfaces with wirebrushes or by sandblasting, removing dust with brush or cloth, removing oil and grease, masking andtaping adjacent surfaces, removing masking and taping. Sometimes it is necessary to lightly sandbetween coats, or size and fill porous materials before painting, all of which is surface preparation.2. Labor for erecting scaffolding not included.
4-109
DIVISION 10. SPECIALTIES
PageA. INSTALL PARTITIONS AND MISCELLANEOUS METAL PRODUCTS
Table 4-118 Install Partitions and Miscellaneous Metal Products . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-109
B. BULLETIN BOARDS, CHALKBOARDS, DIRECTORY BOARDS, AND BATHROOM ACCESSORIESTable 4-119 Bulletin Boards, Chalkboards, Directory Boards,
and Bathroom Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-109
C. MANUFACTURE WOOD CABINETSTable 4-120 Manufacture Wood Cabinets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-110
4-110
This page is blank
4-111
TABLE 4-118. Install Partitions and Miscellaneous Metal Products
Work Element Description Unit Man-HoursPer Unit
Partitions Panel SF 0.104 (5039) Single Panel Doors EA 6.5 (5040) Swing Door, mesh EA 4.0 (5041) Toilet Stalls, complete with doors Stall 10.0 (5042) Wire Mesh SF 0.048 (5043)
Lockers EA 2.0 (5044)
Shelf and Bin Units SF of 0.16 (5046)back area
Security Grills, including track and hardware SF 0.22 (5047)
SUGGESTED CREW SIZE: Two to four men
NOTE: 1. Installation of miscellaneous metal products includes unloading, handing into place, installingfastening devices including drilling, fastening metal products in place, and installing hardware and trim.
TABLE 4-119. Bulletin Boards, Chalkboards, Directory Boards,and Bathroom Accessories
Work Element Description Unit Man-HoursPer Unit
Bulletin Boards, Chalkboards, Directory Boards SF 0.05 (5048)
Bathroom Accessories Each 5.0 (5049) One Set: Mirror and Shelf; Towel Rack; Set Soap Holder; Soap Dispenser; Paper Holder; Paper Towel Dispenser
SUGGESTED CREW SIZE: Two men or more depending on scope of job
NOTE: 1. Installation of specialties include unloading, storing at site, handling into place, installing fasteningdevices including drilling, plugging, anchoring, leveling, and plumbing as needed for bulletin boards,chalkboards, directory boards, and bathroom accessories.
4-112
TABLE 4-120. Manufacture Wood Cabinets
Work Element Description Unit Man-HoursPer Unit
Manufacture Kitchen Cabinets: Based on 8' Lengths Base Unit, no drawers EA 20.0 (5050) Base Unit, with drawers EA 32.0 (5051) Sink Unit EA 24.0 (5052) Wall Unit EA 20.0 (5053) Work Top, including laminated plastic covering FT 0.375 (5054)
Manufacture Book Shelves (cases) FT of 0.5 (5055)Shelf
Install Pre-Manufactured Cabinets 2' to 4' (small) EA 1.5 (5056) 4' to 6' (medium) EA 2.0 (5057) 6' to 10' (large) EA 3.0 (5058)
SUGGESTED CREW SIZE: Two to six BUs
NOTES: 1. The operation of the wood fabrication shop (carpentry shop) includes handling and storing materials,cutting, fitting, planning, mortising, fastening together.2. The laminated plastic covering should not be attached to the work top until the base unit is set andwork top fitted securely in place. A water base contact adhesive (waterproof type) is ideal for bondinglaminate because it can be smoothly applied with paint brush or roller and easily cleaned with water.
4-113
DIVISION 11. ARCHITECTURAL EQUIPMENT
A. LIMITED APPLICATION TO NORMAL SEABEE CONSTRUCTION
B. CONSULT OTHER APPROPRIATE TABLES AS INDICATED BY DESIGN,MATERIALS, SPECIFICATIONS, AND MANUFACTURERS DATA
DIVISION 12. FURNISHINGS
A. CONSULT OTHER APPROPRIATE TABLES AS INDICATED BY DESIGN,MATERIALS, SPECIFICATIONS AND MANUFACTURERS DATA
DIVISION 13. SPECIAL CONSTRUCTION
Tables formerly contained in this division were based on Naval Facilities EngineeringCommand (NAVFACENGCOM) drawings in the NAVFAC P-437, Facilities Planning Guide.
Volume 1 of the NAVFAC P-437, now on CD ROM, contains preengineered facilitydesigns and corresponding material lists. These designs relate primarily to expected needs atadvanced bases and to the Advanced Base Functional Component (ABFC) System. Use of thesedesigns to satisfy peacetime requirements is appropriate. Facilities, logistic, and constructionplanners will find the information required to select and document the material necessary toconstruct facilities. All drawings contained in Volume 1 are reproducible on a CD ROM printer.
Volume 2 of the NAVFAC P-437, now on diskette or on CD ROM, contains the datadisplay for Volume 1. Components are divided into facilities, facilities are divided into assemblies,and assemblies are divided into individual material lists, complete with National Stock Numbers(NSN) and costs. Each division level reflects manpower requirements by Occupational FieldThirteen (OF-13) Seabee rates. These requirements are by total Man-days, with partial man-dayshave been rounded to the next full day, and are based on information derived from this handbook.
DIVISION 14. CONVEYING SYSTEMS
A. LIMITED APPLICATION TO NORMAL SEABEE OPERATIONS
B. CONSULT OTHER APPROPRIATE TABLES AS INDICATED BY DESIGNMATERIALS, SPECIFICATIONS, AND MANUFACTURERS DATA
4-114
This page is blank
4-115
DIVISION 15. MECHANICAL CONSTRUCTIONPage
A. PIPE AND FITTINGSTable 4-121 Install Cast Iron No Hub Pipe and Fittings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-115Table 4-122 Install Types K, L, and M Copper Pipe with
Cast or Wrought Fittings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-115Table 4-123 Install Threaded or Flanged Steel Pipe . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-116Table 4-124 Install Steel Grooved Pipe . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-117Table 4-125 Install CPVC/PVC Solvent Welded Pipe and Fittings. . . . . . . . . . . 4-118Table 4-126 Install Concrete Pipe . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-118Table 4-127 Install Pipe Insulation and Lagging . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-119Table 4-128 Finish Plumbing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-120Table 4-129 Install Compressed Air Systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-121Table 4-130 Install Fire Protection System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-122Table 4-131 Install Galley Equipment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-122
B. HEATING EQUIPMENTTable 4-132 Install Warm Air Furnaces . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-123Table 4-133 Install Heating Boilers, Expansion Tanks, and
Hot Water Storage Heaters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-124Table 4-134 Duct Sheet Metal and Fiberglass . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-125
C. AIR CONDITIONING EQUIPMENTTable 4-135 Install Air Conditioners, Dehumidifiers, and Refrigerators . . . . . . . 4-126Table 4-136 Refrigerant Recovery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-127
4-116
This page is blank
4-117
TABLE 4-121. Install Cast Iron No Hub Pipe and Fittings (in Man-Hours)
UNIT 2IN 3IN 4IN 6IN 8IN 12INPipe FT 0.09 0.14 0.18 0.26 0.37 0.52
(8001) (8002) (8003) (8004) (8005) (8006)Bends EA 0.42 0.49 0.63 0.95 1.19 1.75
(8013) (8014) (8015) (8016) (8017) (8018)Combination Wyes, Tees EA 0.84 0.95 1.26 1.89 2.38 2.42
(8019) (8020) (8021) (8022) (8023) (8024)Reducing Wyes, Tees/Combination EA 0.77 0.84 1.16 1.75 2.31 2.73
(8025) (8026) (8027) (8028) (8029) (8030)1-1/4 to 1-1/2 to 2 Tees, Tapped EA 0.42 0.49 0.63 0.95 1.00 1.75
(8031) (8032) (8033) (8034) (8035) (8036)Crosses, Tapped EA 0.84 0.95 1.26 1.89 2.42 4.69
(8037) (8038) (8039) (8040) (8041) (8042)Reducers EA 0.77 0.84 1.16 1.68 2.17 4.59
(8043) (8044) (8045) (8046) (8047) (8048)Plugs, Clean-out Traps, Closet Bends EA 0.42 0.49 0.63 0.95 1.19
(8049) (8050) (8051) (5052) (8053)1.75
(8054)
SUGGESTED CREW SIZE: Three to six UTs
NOTES: 1. Lifting equipment will be required on larger sizes.2. Straping and securing included in Man-Hour estimate.
TABLE 4-122. Install Types K, L, and M Copper Pipe with Cast or Wrought Fittings (In Man-Hours)
ITEM Unit 1/8 - 3/4" 1" 1-1/4" 1-1/2" 2" 2-1/2" 3" 3-1/2" 4"1/2"
Adapters, EA .25 .28 .41 .64 .74 .98 1.31 1.74 1.90 2.40Caps (8055 (8056 (8057 (8058 (8059 (8060 (8061 (8062 (8063 (8064)
Couplings EA 3.28Elbows .41 .47 .65 1.00 1.25 1.67 2.23 2.98 3.20 (8074)
Tees EA ) ) ) ) ) ) ) ) ) 5.14
Unions EA (8075 (8076 (8077 (8078 (8079 (8080 (8081 (8082 (8083 3.73
Valves, EA .46 .53 .74 1.17 1.37 1.82 2.43 3.23 3.55 4.92Solder (8085 (8086 (8087 (8088 (8089 (8090 (8091 (8092 (8093 (8104)
Pipe and FT 0.149Tubin .56 .62 .88 1.29 1.55 2.26 2.98 3.88 4.62 (8114)
) ) ) ) ) ) ) ) )
(8065 (8066 (8067 (8068 (8069 (8070 (8071 (8072 (8073
.62 .71 .98 1.61 1.88 2.50 3.35 4.47 4.92
) ) ) ) ) ) ) ) ) (8094)
) ) ) ) ) ) ) ) )
(8095 (8096 (8097 (8098 (8099 (8100 (8101 (8102 (8103) ) ) ) ) ) ) ) )
.022 .025 0.28 .040 .043 .043 .047 .065 .074(8105 (8106 (8107 (8108 (8109 (8110 (8111 (8112 (8113
) ) ) ) ) ) ) ) )
(8084)
SUGGESTED CREW SIZE: Two to eight UTsNOTES: 1. Use 1.15 multiplier for silver solder joints.
2. Use 1.1 multiplier for overall tasking for straping and securing.
4-118
TABLE 4-123. Install Threaded or Flanged Steel Pipe
(In Man-Hours)Item Unit 1/2" 3/4" 1" 1-1/4" 1-1/2" 2" 3" 4" 6"
Pipe FT 0.07 0.07 0.09 0.10 0.10 0.12 0.16 0.19 0.28
Elbows, Couplings, EA 0.45 0.57 0.69 0.81 0.90 1.01 1.55 2.18 3.31Reducers (8128) (8129) (8130) (8131) (8132) (8133) (8134) (8135) (8136)
Tees EA 0.67 0.85 1.03 1.21 1.34 1.52 2.33 3.27 4.97
Caps, Plugs, EA 0.25 0.33 0.37 0.43 0.48 0.54 0.82 1.12 1.72Bushings (8146) (8147) (8148) (8149) (8150) (8151) (8152) (8153) (8154)
Crosses (8155) (8156) (8157) (8158) (8159) (8160) (8161) (8162) (8163)
Nipples (8164) (8165) (8166) (8167) (8168) (8169) (8170) (8171) (8172)
Valves (Screw Type) (8173) (8174) (8175) (8176) (8177) (8178) (8179) (8180) (8181)
Flanges (8182) (8183) (8184) (8185) (8186) (8187) (8188) (8189) (8190)
Unions (8191) (8192) (8193) (8194) (8195) (8196) (8197) (8198) (8199)
EA 0.90 1.13 1.37 1.61 1.79 2.03 3.10 4.36 6.63
EA 0.09 0.12 0.15 0.18 0.18 0.22 0.34 0.59 0.60
EA 0.54 0.67 0.82 0.99 1.07 1.19 1.82 2.63 3.99
EA 0.45 0.45 0.45 0.49 0.49 0.49 0.55 0.90 0.98
EA 0.48 0.60 0.72 0.83 0.93 1.04 1.58 2.21 3.34
(8119) (8120) (8121) (8122) (8123) (8124) (8125) (8126) (8127)
(8137) (8138) (8139) (8140) (8141) (8142) (8143) (8144) (8145)
SUGGESTED CREW SIZE: Two to six UTs
NOTE: 1. Includes cutting, fitting, installation.
4-119
TABLE 4-124. Install Steel Grooved Pipe (Single or Double Groove)
(In Man-Hours)
Pipe Size UNIT 1" 2" 4" 5" 6" 8" 10" 12" 14" 16" 18"(Inches)
Elbows, EA .16 .21 .42 .60 .62 .83 .96 1.08 1.37 1.58 1.79Reducers (8501) (8502) (8503) (8504) (8505) (8506) (8507) (8508) (8509) (8510) (8511)
Tees EA .23 .31 .62 .90 .94 1.25 1.44 1.62 2.03 2.37 2.68
Adapters EA .13 .16 .40 .59 .61 .66 .77 .98 1.16 1.34 1.48
Crosses EA .29 .39 .80 1.10 1.19 1.59 1.84 2.06 2.59 3.01 3.39
Valves EA .16 .21 .42 .60 .63 .83 .96 1.08 1.29 1.58 1.79
Couplings (77) EA .08 .10 .21 .30 .31 .42 .48 .54 .68 .79 .89
Couplings EA .06 .07 .16 .23 .24 .31 .36 .40 .51 .59 .66(780/81) (8567) (8568) (8569) (8570) (8571) (8572) (8573) (8574) (8575) (8576) (8577)
Wyes EA .24 .35 .60 .88 .90 1.19 1.38 1.51 1.91 2.21 2.52
(8512) (8513) (8514) (8515) (8516) (8517) (8518) (8519) (8520) (8521) (8522)
(8523) (8524) (8525) (8526) (8527) (8528) (8529) (8530) (8531) (8532) (8533)
(8534) (8535) (8536) (8537) (8538) (8539) (8540) (8541) (8542) (8543) (8544)
(8545) (8546) (8547) (8548) (8549) (8550) (8551) (8552) (8553) (8554) (8555)
(8556) (8557) (8558) (8559) (8560) (8561) (8562) (8563) (8564) (8565) (8566)
(8578) (8579) (8580) (8581) (8582) (8583) (8584) (8585) (8586) (8587) (8588)
SUGGESTED CREW SIZE: Two to four UTs
NOTES: 1. Lifting equipment will be required on larger sized (12 inches and above.)2. Time includes placing and leveling.
4-120
TABLE 4-125. Install CPVC/PVC Solvent Welded Pipe and Fittings (Schedule 40)
(In Man-Hours)
Pipe Size (Inches) Unit 1/2- 1" 1-1/2" 2" 2-1/2" 3" 4" 6" 8" 10-12"3/4"
45-90 Els and EA .20 .20 .20 .20 .30 0.35 .40 .45 .45 .500
Couplings (8201) (8202) (8203) (8204) (8205) (8206) (8207) (8208) (8209) (8210)Tees EA .30 .30 .30 .30 .35 .40 .55 .60 .60 .65
Adapters EA .22 .22 .22 .22 .43 .53 .65 .65 .70 .75
Unions EA .28 .28 .28 .28 .33 .40 .40 .45 .45 .50
Flanges EA .15 .15 .15 .15 .20 .20 .25 .30 .30 .35
Bolt-Up EA .30 .30 .30 .33 .37 .37 .60 .60 .65 .70
Valves EA .40 .40 .45 .45 .45 .55 .60 .65 .65 .70
Pipe FT .02 .03 .05 .06 .07 .10 .10 .13 .13 .19
(8211) (8212) (8213) (8214) (8215) (8216) (8217) (8218) (8219) (8220)
(8221) (8222) (8223) (8224) (8225) (8226) (8227) (8228) (8229) (8230)
(8231) (8232) (8233) (8234) (8235) (8236) (8237) (8238) (8239) (8240)
(8241) (8242) (8243) (8244) (8245) (8246) (8247) (8248) (8249) (8250)
(8251) (8252) (8253) (8254) (8255) (8256) (8257) (8258) (8259) (8260)
(8261) (8262) (8263) (8264) (8265) (8266) (8267) (8268) (8269) (8270)
(8271) (8272) (8273) (8274) (8275) (8276) (8277) (8278) (8279) (8280)
SUGGESTED CREW SIZE: Two to four UTs
NOTES: 1. Figures include cleaning, applying solvent and drying time, installation of hangers and supports.2. PVC Solvent will not work with CPVC. Each must have their own solvent cement.3. For Schedule 80 pipe use 1.5 multiplier.
TABLE 4-126. Install Concrete Pipe
Work Element Description Unit Man-HoursPer Unit
12-Inch Diameter FT .2 (8291)18-Inch Diameter FT .34 (8292)24-Inch Diameter FT .46 (8293)30-Inch Diameter FT .80 (8294)36-Inch Diameter FT 1.0 (8295)48-Inch Diameter FT 1.17 (8296)
SUGGESTED CREW SIZE: Four to eight UTs
NOTES: 1. Lifting equipment required for all sizes of concrete pipe.2. Man-hours estimates for manholes or catch basins based on making tie into existing manholes orcatch basins.3. Types of cement pipe joins: concrete, oakum, mortar, and speed seal.
4-121
TABLE 4-127. Install Pipe Insulation and Lagging
Work Element Description Unit Man-HoursPer Unit
Install Magnesia Covering: 1-1/2 inch and smaller FT 0.30 (8297) 2 inch to 3 inch FT 0.35 (8298) 3-1/2 inch to 4 inch FT 0.40 (8299) 5 inch to 6 inch FT 0.45 (8300)
Install Fiberglass Covering with Metal: 1-1/2 inch and smaller FT 0.30 (8301) 2 inch to 3 inch FT 0.35 (8302) 3-1/2 inch to 4 inch FT 0.40 (8203) 4 inch to 6 inch FT 0.45 (8304 6 inch to 8 inch FT 0.50 (8305) 8 inch to 10 inch FT 0.70 (8306)
Install Molded Cork Covering: 1-1/2 inch and smaller FT 0.30 (8307) 2 inch to 3 inch FT 0.35 (8308) 3-1/2 inch to 4 inch FT 0.50 (8309)
SUGGESTED CREW SIZE: Two to six UTs, depending on pipe size and job scope
NOTE: 1. Work includes the following items: mudding fittings and valves; installing metal lagging; andwater proofing valves and fittings.
4-122
TABLE 4-128. Finished Plumbing
Work Element Description Unit Man-HoursPer Unit
Bathtub EA 9.0 (8310)Bathtub and Shower EA 9.0 (8311)Floor Drain (to 4-inch diameter) EA 2.0 (8312)Grease Trap, Single Cast Iron EA 6.0 (8313)Kitchen Sink, Single EA 3.0 (8314)Kitchen Sink, Double EA 4.0 (8315)Laundry Tubs EA 5.0 (8316)Lavatory, Wall Hung EA 3.0 (8317)Lavatory, Pedestal EA 5.0 (8318)Shower and Stall EA 5.0 (8319)Service Sink, Slop Sink EA 6.0 (8320)Urinal, Wall Hung EA 2.5 (8321)Urinal, Pedestal or Floor EA 3.0 (8322)Water Closet and Tank EA 3.0 (8323)Water Closet and Tank, Wall Hung EA 5.0 (8324)Water Heater, Electric: Plumbing only 40-60 gals., and Vent EA 3.0 (8325)Drinking Fountains, Wall Hung or Floor Mounted EA 3.0 (8326)Test (per fixture) EA 0.75 (8327)
SUGGESTED CREW SIZE: One to two UTs
NOTE: 1. Work includes setting and connecting all supply piping, plumbing fixtures and trim.
4-123
TABLE 4-129. Install Compressed Air System
Work Element Description Unit Man-HoursPer Unit
Supply Piping 1/2 inch FT 0.07 (8328) 1/4 inch FT 0.07 (8329) 1 inch FT 0.09 (8330) 1-1/2 inch FT 0.09 (8331) 2 inch FT 0.12 (8332)
Valves 1/2 inch EA 0.53 (8333) 3/4 inch EA 0.67 (8334) 1 inch EA 0.82 (8335) 1-1/2 inch EA 1.00 (8336) 2 inch EA 1.00 (8337)
Hangers, Overhead Wood Joists or Concrete Insert 1/2 inch EA 0.50 (8338) 3/4 inch EA 0.50 (8339) 1 inch EA 0.50 (8340) 1-1/2 inch EA 0.60 (8341) 2 inch EA 0.60 (8342)
Install Hose Reels EA 4.00 (8343)
Install Electric Driven Compressor Tank 5 CFM to 20 CFM EA 11.00 (8344) 25 CFM to 50 CFM EA 14.00 (8345)
Install Electric Motor and Compressor on Anchor Bolts 100 CFM to 250 CFM EA 24.00 (8346) 275 CFM to 500 CFM EA 47.00 (8347) 550 CFM to 750 CFM EA 60.00 (8348)
SUGGESTED CREW SIZE: Two to four UTs, depending on job scope
NOTES: 1. Use 1.2 multiplier if gas or diesel engines are used.2. Use 1.1 multiplier for scaffold or ladder work.
4-124
TABLE 4-130. Install Fire Protection Systems
Work Element Description Unit Man-HoursPer Unit
Riser and Supply Piping, including Valves. (See tables 4-105 or 4-107)
Sprinkler Heads, including Laterals and Hangers Pendant EA 2.0 (8349) Upright EA 1.5 (8350)
Hose Cabinets, complete with Glass Door, Hose and Nozzle EA 15.0 (8351)
Hose Racks, complete with Nozzle EA 9.0 (8352)
Does not include Electrical Alarm System
SUGGESTED CREW SIZE: Two to four UTs, depending on scope of job
TABLE 4-131. Install Galley Equipment
Work Element Description Man-HoursPer Unit
Deep Fat Fryer (Electric0 6.0 (8353)Dishwasher (3HP, 208 Volts, 3PH) 16.0 (8354)Grill (208 Volts) 6.0 (8355)Kittle, 20-60 gals. 12.0 (8356)Oven Bake (Oil Fired) 10.0 (8357)Range (Oil Fired) 10.0 (8358)Refrigerator, 15 CF, and smaller 4.0 (8359)Refrigerator, 20 to 60 CF 8.0 (8360)Steam Talbe 16.0 (8361)Urn (Steam) 8.0 (8362)Work Tables 1.0 (8363)Cooker 8.0 (8364)
SUGGESTED CREW SIZE: Two to four UTs, depending on size of equipment and job scope
NOTES: 1. Man-hour estimates include assembly and placing equipment. Figures include traps and strainer,vals and drip legs, relief val, reducing vals.2. Does not include hard wiring to panel.
4-125
TABLE 4-132. Install Warm Air Furnaces
Work Element Description Unit Man-HoursPer Unit
Set and Connect Warm Air Furnaces Complete (less Duct,Diffusers, and Hard Wiring) 100,000 BTU and smaller EA 17.0 (8365) 105,000 BTU to 145,000 BTU EA 36.0 (8366) 145,000 BTU to 280,000 BTU EA 56.0 (8367) 450,000 BTU to 750,000 BTU EA 109.0 (8368) 1,000,000 BTU to 2,000,000 BTU EA 159.0 (8369)
Fuel Oil Storage Tanks Set on Floor 275 to 500 GL EA 15.0 (8370) 1,000 to 2,000 GL EA 28.0 (8371) 5,000 GL EA 55.0 (8372)
SUGGESTED CREW SIZE: Two to four UTs, depending on size of equipment and job scope
NOTES: 1. Man-hour figures include the positioning and connecting of units complete with fans, filters, safetycontrols, and light oil burners.2. Man-hour figures for installation of fuel storage tanks set on floors includes supports, saddles,coatings, and fittings.
4-126
TABLE 4-133. Install Heating Boilers, Expansion Tanks, andHot Water Storage Heaters (Heat Exchangers)
Work Element Description Unit Man-HoursPer Unit
Set and connect Iron Sectional Boilers withInsulating Jacket and Safety Devices 95,000 BTU/Hr. and smaller EA 21.0 (8373) 100,000 to 250,000 BTU/Hr. EA 29.0 (8374) 260,000 to 450,000 BTU/Hr. EA 43.0 (8375) 500,000 to 750,000 BTU/Hr. EA 60.0 (8376) 800,000 to 1,000,000 BTU/Hr. EA 90.0 (8377) 1,050,000 to 1,500,000 BTU/Hr. EA 127.0 (8378)
Set and connect Expansion Tanks 50 GL and smaller EA 8.0 (8379) 55 to 100 GL EA 13.0 (8380)
Set and connect Hot Water Storage Heaters 80 GL and smaller EA 12.0 (8381) 81 to 150 GL EA 17.0 (8382) 151 to 300 GL EA 33.0 (8383)
SUGGESTED CREW SIZE: Two to four UTs, depending on equipment size and job scope. TwoEOs required for larger equipment item placement
NOTES: 1. Mechanical or powered lifting equipment required for larger items.2. Piping and electrical systems not included in man-hour figures.3. For steel packed boilers use 0.8 multiplier.
4-127
TABLE 4-134. Duct Sheet Metal and Fiberglass
Work Element Description Unit Man-HoursPer Unit
Fabricate Sheet Metal Duct 20-inch to 94-inch perimeter 96-inch to 126-inch perimeter 128-inch to 190-inch perimeter 192-inch to 240-inch perimeter 242-inch to 360-inch perimeter
FTFTFTFTFT
0.340 (8384)0.650 (8385)0.980 (8386)1.220 (8387)1.490 (8388)
Install Sheet Metal Duct (rectangular) 20-inch to 94-inch perimeter 96-inch to 126-inch perimeter 128-inch to 190-inch perimeter 192-inch to 240-inch perimeter 242-inch to 360-inch perimeterInstall Sheet Metal Duct (round) 20-inch to 94-inch perimiter 94-inch to 126-inch perimiter 127-inch to 190-inch perimiter 191-inch to 240-inch perimiter 241-inch to 360-inch perimiter
FTFTFTFTFT
FTFTFTFTFT
0.420 (8389)0.700 (8390)1.440 (8391)2.000 (8392)2.640 (8393)
0.525 (8407)0.875 (8408)
1.8 (8409)2.5 (8410)3.3 (8411)
Insulate Sheet Metal Duct FT 0.060 (8394)
Install Fibre Duct for Slab Heating or Cooling System 6-inch inside diameter 8-inch inside diameter 10-inch inside diameter 12-inch inside diameter 16-inch inside diameter 20-inch inside diameter 24-inch inside diameter
FTFTFTFTFTFTFT
0.020 (8395)0.022 (8396)0.022 (8397)0.025 (8398)0.032 (8399)0.042 (8400)0.060 (8401)
Fabrication FT 0.280 (8402)
Installation includes Hangers, does not include Grills and Registers
Grills and Registers (Plaster Ground) 4 inch X 8 inch 6 inch X 12 inch 16 inch X 16 inch 20 inch X 36 inch
EAEAEAEA
0.030 (8403)0.090 (8404)0.100 (8405)0.130 (8406)
SUGGESTED CREW SIZE: Two to six SWs, depending on job scope
NOTES: 1. Fabrication is to be performed in the sheet metal shop.2. Time for grills and registers will vary according to type of materials used in ceilings and walls.3. Installation of fiberglass duct will vary with manufacturer.
4-128
TABLE 4-135. Install Air Conditioners, Dehumidifiers, and Refrigerators
Work Element Description Unit Man-HoursPer Unit
Install Window Type Air Conditioners 1/2 to 3/4 ton EA 3.0 (8413) 1 to 1-1/2 ton EA 5.0 (8414) 2 ton EA 7.0 (8415)Install Self-Contained Air Conditioning Units 3 to 5 ton EA 24.0 (8416) 5 to 8 ton EA 32.0 (8417) 10 to 15 ton EA 48.0 (8418)Install Air Conditioning Equipment 25 ton system EA 240.0 (8419) 26 to 50 ton system EA 384.0 (8420) 51 to 785 ton system EA 560.0 (8421) 76 to 100 ton system EA 840.0 (8422)Set and Connect Dehumidifiers (per CUBIC FOOT of space) CF 0.002 (8423)Heat Pumps, Air-to-Air Split Systems 2 ton cooling - 8.5 MBH heating EA 20.0 (8424) 5 ton cooling - 27 MBH heating EA 47.0 (8425) 7 ton cooling - 33 MBH heating EA 79.0 (8426) 10 ton cooling - 50 MBH heating EA 94.0 (8427) 15 ton cooling - 64 MBH heating EA 137.0 (8428) 40 ton cooling - 193 MBH heating EA 397.0 (8429)Heat Pumps, Air-to-Air Single Package 2 ton cooling - 6.5 MBH heating EA 20.0 (8430) 4 ton cooling - 13 MBH heating EA 23.0 (8431) 7 ton cooling - 35 MBH heating EA 59.0 (8432) 15 ton cooling - 56 MBH heating EA 117.0 (8433)Water Chillers, Reciprocating Air Cooled 20 ton EA 143.0 (8434) 40 ton EA 191.0 (8435) 65 ton EA 340.0 (8436) 100 ton EA 477.0 (8437)Water Chillers, Water Cooled 20 ton EA 131.0 (8438) 50 ton EA 226.0 (8439) 100 ton EA 397.0 (8440) 140 ton EA 529.0 (8441)Erect and Connect Walk-In Refrigerators 150 CF EA 6.0 (8442) 600 CF EA 42.0 (8443) 1800 CF EA 50.0 (8444) 4000 CF EA 92.0 (8445)Testing Self contain unit (A/c, Heat Pump, Refrigirator up to 200 CF) EA 2.0 (8446) Unit 1/2-15 ton EA 8.0 (8447) Unit 15-25 ton EA 12.0 (8448) Unit 26-50 ton EA 16..0 (8449) Unit 51-75 ton EA 24.0 (8450) Unit 76-100 ton EA 32.0 (8451)
SUGGESTED CREW SIZE: Two to six UTs
NOTES: 1. Man-hour figures setting and connecting all equipment except remote coils or units2. Man-hour figures do not include the installation of piping or electrical between various pieces ofequipment, installation of ductwork or diffusers, curbs, or slabs.
4-129
TABLE 4-136. Refrigerant Recovery
Work Element Description Unit Man-HoursPer Unit
Recover Refrigerant 1/2 to 3/4 ton TN 1.00 (8461) 1 to 1-1/2 ton TN 1.50 (8462) 2 ton TN 2.25 (8463)
Retrofit to Non-CFC Refrigerant 1/2 to 3/4 ton unit EA 4.00 (8471) 1 to 1-1/2 ton unit EA 7.00 (8472) 2 to 3 ton unit EA 12.00 (8473) 3-1/2 to 5 ton unit EA 16.00 (8474) 5-1/2 to 8 ton unit EA 22.00 (8475) 8-1/2 to 12 ton unit EA 30.00 (8476)
NOTES: 1. Man-hour figures may vary by ambient temperature and capacity of recovery unit.2. Retrofit figures include four-step process: (a) Recover refrigerant; (b) Empty oil; (c) Changefilter/drier to XH7/9; (d) Fill new oil; (e) Evacuate system; (f) Recharge non-CFC refrigerant.3. Repeat steps four times.
4-130
This page is blank
4-131
DIVISION 16. ELECTRICAL CONSTRUCTIONPage
A. OVERHEAD ELECTRICAL SYSTEMSTable 4-137 Electrical Line Work:
General Information on Setting Poles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-131Table 4-138 Digging Pole and Anchor Holes:
General Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-131Table 4-139 Overhead Primary and Secondary Conductors and Devices . . . . . . . 4-132Table 4-140 Street and Security Lighting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-133Table 4-141 Athletic Facility Lighting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-134
B. UNDERGROUND SYSTEMSTable 4-142 Underground Power Systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-135
C. WIRING SYSTEMSTable 4-143 Electrical Rough-In (Housing and Barracks) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-136Table 4-144 Electrical Finish and Trim (Housing and Barracks) . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-137Table 4-145 Electrical Rough-In (Industrial) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-138Table 4-146 Conduit Spacings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-139Table 4-147 Electrical Finish and Trim (Industrial) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-139
D. TRANSFORMER AND SUBSTATION EQUIPMENTTable 4-148 Substation Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-140
E. BURGLAR AND FIRE ALARM SYSTEMSTable 4-149 Fire Alarm and Signal Systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-141
F. COMMUNICATION SYSTEMSTable 4-150 Overhead Telephone Line Construction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-142Table 4-151 Interior Telephone Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-142Table 4-152 Underground Telephone Line Construction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-143Table 4-153 Installing Intercommunication Systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-144
4-132
This page is blank
4-133
TABLE 4-137. Electrical Line Work:General Information on Setting Poles
Pole Length Unit Line Truck Crane Pike-Methodin Feet Man-Hours Man-Hours Man-Hours
20 to 35 EA 3.2 (9001) 3.2 (9002) 6.4 (9003)40 to 50 EA 4.0 (9004) 4.0 (9005)55 to 60 EA 4.0 (9006) 4.0 (9007)65 to 80 EA 6.3 (9008) 4.8 (9009)
SUGGESTED CREW SIZE: Line Truck Method: Four CEsCrane Method: Four CEsPike Pole Method: Eight CEs
NOTES: 1. Time for setting poles includes backfilling and tamping.2. Man-hours based on normal working conditions and average terrain.3. Use 1.1 multiplier for framing.
TABLE 4-138. Digging Pole and Anchor Holes:General Information
Pole Holes Hand Digging Hand Digging Machine Digging Machine DiggingDepth in Feet Man-Hours Man-Hours Man-Hours Man-Hours
per Hole per Hole per Hole per Hole
In Soil In Rock In Soil In Rock
4 0.8 (9010) 4.0 (9011) 0.5 (9012) 1.0 (9013)5 0.8 (9014) 4.8 (9015) 0.5 (9016) 1.0 (9017)6 1.6 (9018) 5.6 (9019) 0.5 (9020) 1.2 (9021)7 1.6 (9022) 6.4 (9023) 0.6 (9024) 1.2 (9025)8 1.6 (9026) 7.2 (9027) 0.6 (9028) 1.6 (9029)
Anchor Holes In Soil In Rock In Soil In RockDepth in Feet
4 0.8 (9030) 4.0 (9031) 0.5 (9032) 1.0 (9033)6 1.6 (9034) 5.6 (9035) 0.5 (9036) 1.2 (9037)8 1.6 (9038) 7.2 (9039) 0.5 (9040) 1.6 (9041)
SUGGESTED CREW SIZE: Hand Digging Operations: Two CEsPower Digging Operations: One EO; Auger truck: Two CEs
NOTES: 1. Times for anchor holes includes backfill, tamping, and securing tail of guy.2. Times for machine digging include setting up machine.3. When using power installed screw anchor machines, Use 0.5 multiplier.4. Pole hole depth is determined by:Length of pole, in feet, divided by 10; plus 1 foot for rock or 2 feet for dirt; equals Depth of Hole.
4-134
TABLE 4-139. Overhead Primary and Secondary Conductors and Devices
Work Element Description Unit Man-HoursPer Unit
Cross Assembly (standard 8 FT arm) Single Arm EA 4.0 (9042) Double Arm EA 5.6 (9043)
Install Guys (common grade seven strand) Down Guys EA 4.0 (9044) Head Guys EA 6.4 (9045)
Construct H-Frame and Install Three Phase Transformer Bank EA 132.0 (4046)
String Primary Conductors AWG #6 to AWG #1 Bare Copper FT 0.016 (9047)AWG #0 to AWG #0000 Bare Copper FT 0.0232 (9048)Larger than AWG #0000 Bare Copper FT 0.0328 (9049)
Install Transformer on Poles Single Transformer 10 to 75 kVA EA 12.0 (9050) Three Single-Phase Transformer 10 to 75 kVA Bank 16.0 (9051)
Install Secondary Racks EA 2.4 (9052)
Install Secondary Conductors and Service Drops AWG #4 and Smaller: Four wire, weatherproof FT 0.053 (9053) AWG #2 to AWG #0: Four wire, weatherproof FT 0.069 (9054)
Install Voltage Regulators 25 kVA, Single Phase, Pole Mounted EA 17.6 (9055) 75 to 125 kVA, Three Phase, Slab Mounted EA 81.6 (9056)
Capacitor Units, Pole Mounted, Factory Preassembled,All kVA ratings EA 16.8 (9057)
Install Primary Protective Devices Pole Top Air Break Switches, Three Pole EA 43.2 (9058) Enclosed-Fused Disconnect Switch EA 8.0 (9059) Open-Fused Disconnect Switch EA 8.0 (9060)
SUGGESTED CREW SIZE:Single Cross Assembly Installation: Two CEs (one lineman, one groundman) Double Arm Installation: Three CEs (two linemen, one groundman)Install Wire Guys: Three CEs (two linemen, one groundman) Install Primary Protective Devices: Four CEs (two linemen, two groundmenH-Frame: Six CEs (four linemen, two groundmen) Capacitor Units: Three CEs (two linemen, one groundman)String Primary Conductors: Ten CEs (four linemen, six groundmen) Install Voltage Regulators: Three CEs (two linemen, one groundman)Install Transformers on Poles: Four CEs (two linemen, two groundmen) Install Secondary Racks: Two CEs (one lineman, one groundman)Install Secondary Conductors and Service: Two CEs (one linemen, one groundman)
NOTE: 1. Crossarm Assembly figures are based on work being done before pole is set. If work must be done after pole is set, use 1.15 multiplier.2. When using Bucket Truck use 0.85 multiplier.
4-135
TABLE 4-140. Street and Security Lighting
Work Element Description Unit Man-HoursPer Unit
Install Foundations for Metal Standards EA 12.0 (9061)1
Install Metal Light Standards (30 FT)2
Aluminum Standard EA 11.2 (9062) Steel Standard EA 12.0 (9063)
Install Wooden Street Light Pole EA 11.2 (9064)3
Install Wooden Floodlight Pole (Two Floods) EA 9.6 (9065)
String One Conductor for Series Lighting FT 0.0208 (9066)4
Connect Streetlight Floodlight to Power EA 4.8 (9067)5
Install Lighting Transformer EA 12.0 (9068)
Install Constant Current Regulator and Control Devicesfor Street Lighting Installed in Vault EA 6.4 (9069) Installed on Pole EA 8.0 (9070)
SUGGESTED CREW SIZES:Install Foundations for Metal Standards: One CEInstall Metal Light Standards: Two CEs, one EO with craneInstall Streetlight/Floodlight Pole: Two CEsString One Conductor for Series Lighting: Two CEsConnect Streetlight/Floodlight to Power: Two CEs
NOTES: 1. CE work includes approximately 10 feet of 2-inch rigid steel conduit and pull box.2. Assembly and wiring performed on the ground.3. Work is the same as Overhead Power Construction. If light is to be added to existing pole.4. Work is approximately the same as Overhead Power Construction. Use 30 percent of primaryconductors Man-hours for series circuits. Secondary installation of floodlights is the same assecondary conductors and service drops.5. Work does not include installation of power source.6. Refer to table 4-126 for man-hours figures for excavating and burial of power cables.7. To install foundations for metal standards, increase crew size to include one BU.
4-136
TABLE 4-141. Athletic Facility Lighting
SUGGESTED CREW SIZE: Refer to the various tables listed below for specific constructiontasks.
Dig Pole and Anchor Holes: . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table 4-122Frame, Set, and Guy Poles: . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table 4-121Install Transformers: . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table 4-123Install Overhead Wiring: . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table 4-123Install Underground Wiring: . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table 4-126Install Disconnect Switches and Related Hardware: . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table 4-123Install, Connect, and Aim Floodlights: . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table 4-124
NOTES: 1. Use IES Type 5 (70 to 100 ) or IES Type 6 (100 to 130 ) beam spread floodlights in all0 0 0 0
applications. High Pressure Sodium or Mercury Vapor floodlights with high power factor ballastsare preferred.2. All calculations of man-hours are determined from other tables in this manual.3. Lighting requirements for various athletic facilities are:
Football (Class IV or V) and Soccer 20 FootcandlesSoftball, semi-pro: Infield 30 Footcandles
Outfield 20 FootcandlesTennis (Club Play) 20 FootcandlesVolleyball and Basketball (Recreational) 10 Footcandles
4-137
TABLE 4-142. Underground Power System
Work Element Description Unit Man-HoursPer Unit
Excavate Trench for Duct or Direct Burial of Cable Hard Excavating CD 13.6 (9071) Machine Excavating FT 0.011 (9072)
Install 4-Inch Transite Duct2
Two Conduits without Concrete FT 0.051 (9073)
Encasement Four Conduits without Concrete FT 0.085 (9074) Two Conduits Encased in 3-Inch Concrete FT 0.08 (9075) Four Conduits Encased in 3-Inch Concrete FT 0.072 (9076)
Install Direct Burial Cable in Trench Up to AWG #0. Three Conductor FT 0.086 (9077) AWG #00 to 500 MCM. Three Conductor FT 0.179 (9078)
Pull Cable into Duct AWG #6. Three Conductor FT 0.058 (9079) AWG #2. Three Conductor FT 0.11 (9080) AWG #0000. Three Conductor FT 0.178 (9081)
Underground Service to Building 3 AWG #2. Four Conductor FT 0.144 (9082) AWG #0. Four Conductor FT 0.224 (9083)
SUGGESTED CREW SIZE:Trench Excavation: Two EOs with ditching machine; Two CEsInstalling Duct: Six CEsInstalling Underground Service: Three CEs
NOTES: 1. All excavating is figured on average soil conditions.2. Duct man-hour figures allow for a normal number of bends, bells, fittings, and installing pullline.3. Work includes setting up cable reel, measuring and cutting to length, pulling cable into buildingand identifying conductors.4. Direct burial cable in trench requires sand bed.5. Concrete encasement under roadway requires reinforcing steel (include one SW).6. When using mechanical-cable puller use 0.85 multiplier.
4-138
TABLE 4-143. Electrical Rough-In (Housing and Barracks)
Work Element Description Unit Man-Hours Per UnitInstall Service Main, Four-Wire Conductor1
60 Ampere EA 11.2 (9084) 100 Ampere EA 13.8 (9085) 200 Ampere EA 15.2 (9086) 400 Ampere EA 19.2 (9087)Install Rigid Steel Conduit2
½ inch to 3/4 inch FT 0.16 (9088) 1 inch to 1-1/2 inch FT 0.2 (9089) 2 inch to 3 inch FT 0.304 (9090) 3-1/2 inch to 4 inch FT 0.352 (9091)Install Thinwall (EMT) and Flexible Conduit3
½ inch to 3/4 inch FT 0.072 (9092) 1 inch to 1-1/2 inch FT 0.096 (9093) 2 inch to 2-1/2 inch FT 0.136 (9000) 3 inch to 4 inch FT 0.192 (9094)Install 8 FT Ground Rod and Ground Wire EA 2.4 (9095)Install Type NM Cable4
AWG #10/3 with Ground and Smaller FT 0.026 (9096) AWG #8/2 with Ground and Larger FT 0.056 (9097)Install Boxes for Type NM Cable EA 0.32 (9098)5
Install Pull Boxes6
12 X 12 X 6 Inches, NEMA Type 1 EA 2.4 (9099) 16 X 20 X 8 Inches, NEMA Type 1 EA 3.2 (9100) 24 X 36 X 8 Inches, NEMA Type 1 EA 4.8 (9101) 6 X 6 X 6 Inches, NEMA Type 3R and 4 EA 2.4 (9102) 10 X 6 X 6 Inches, NEMA Type 3R and 4 EA 4.8 (9103) 16 X 16 X 6 Inches, NEMA Type 3R and 4 EA 7.2 (9104) 24 X 18 X 8 Inches, NEMA Type 3R and 4 EA 12.0 (9105)Pull Wire In Conduit, 3-600 V Conductors #7 AWG #12 FT 0.009 (9106) AWG #10 FT 0.01 (9107) AWG #8 FT 0.12 (9108) AWG #6 FT 0.16 (9109) AWG #4 FT 0.21 (9110) AWG #1 FT 0.33 (9111) AWG #1/0 FT 0.39 (9112) AWG #2/0 FT 0.43 (9113) AWG #3/0 FT 0.49 (9114) AWG #4/0 FT 0.58 (9115) AWG #350 MCM FT 0.78 (9116) AWG #500 MCM FT 0.96 (9117)
SUGGESTED CREW SIZE: Three CEs
NOTES: 1. Use 1.25 multiplier for underground service.2. For installation in concrete slabs increase use 0.5 multiplier. For intermediate Metal Conduit(MC) use 0.75 multiplier.3. For installation on concrete increase use 0.9 multiplier.4. Surface Mounted on wood or behind wall or ceiling.5. Plastic or metal boxes on wood surface or behind wall or in ceiling.6. Includes attaching conduit to pull box.7. Time includes reel set-up and removal.
4-139
TABLE 4-144. Electrical Finish and Trim (Housing and Barracks)
Work Element Description Unit Man-HoursPer Unit
Install Receptacles and Plates Duplex Convenience Outlets EA 0.4 (9118) Range and Dryer Receptacles EA 1.6 (9119)
Install Standard Grade Toggle Switches and Plates Single Pole EA 0.32 (9120) Three or Four Way EA 0.4 (9121)
Install Incandescent Lighting Fixturesup to 150 Watt. Medium Base Surface Mounted EA 1.6 (9122) Flush Mounted EA 1.6 (9123) Porcelain Lampholder EA 0.32 (9124)
Install Fluorescent Lighting Fixtures EA 2.4 (9125)1
Install Fluorescent Tubes and Diffusers EA 1.6 (9126)
Connect Small Appliances: Water Heater (80 gal. capacity) EA 3.2 (9127) Space Heater (2000 watts) EA 1.6 (9128) Air Conditioning Units (up to 18000 BTU) EA 4.0 (9129) Exhaust Fans EA 4.8 (9130)
Testing: Receptacles, Switches, Lighting Fixtures EA 0.08 (9260) Small Appliances EA 0.4 (9261)
SUGGESTED CREW SIZE: Two CEs
NOTE: 1. Two or four tube, surface, stem, or chain mounted on wood or masonry. Commercialindustrial, residential: normal high output or power groove type.
4-140
TABLE 4-145. Electrical Rough-In (Industrial)
Work Element Description Unit Man-HoursPer Unit
Install Safety Switch, Three Pole, General or Heavy Duty 3
30 Ampere EA 2.4 (9131) 60 Ampere EA 3.2 (9132) 100 Ampere EA 4.0 (9133) 225 Ampere EA 7.2 (9134) 400 Ampere EA 11.2 (9135) 600 Ampere EA 17.6 (9136)
Install Circuit Breakers, Enclosed, NEMAType 1, 600 Volt, Three Pole 30 Ampere EA 2.4 (9137) 60 Ampere EA 3.2 (9138) 100 Ampere EA 4.8 (9139) 225 Ampere EA 6.4 (9140) 400 Ampere EA 11.2 (9141) 600 Ampere EA 17.6 (9142)
Install Panel Boards, Lighting, and Power Four-Wire, Three-Phase, 100 to 225 Ampere Main Lugs 12 Circuits or less EA 9.6 (9143) 13 to 20 Circuits EA 16.0 (9144) 21 to 24 Circuits EA 17.6 (9145) 25 to 30 Circuits EA 20.0 (9146) 31 to 36 Circuits EA 23.2 (9147) 37 to 42 Circuits EA 26.4 (9148)
Install Wireway, 5-Ft. Length, Screw Cover withFittings and Supports 4 Inches X 4 Inches FT 0.32 (9149) 6 Inches X 6 Inches FT 0.32 (9150) 8 Inches X 8 Inches FT 0.48 (9151)
Install Cable Trays, Ladder Type, Galvanized Steel with Fittings and Supports 12-Inches Wide FT 0.248 (9152) 18-Inches Wide FT 0.28 (9153) 24-Inches Wide FT 0.32 (9154)
SUGGESTED CREW SIZE: Two CEs
NOTES: 1. For explosion-proof work use 3.0 multiplier.2. All work estimates based on surface mounting.3. For aluminum cable trays use 1.05 multiplier.
4-141
TABLE 4-146. Conduit Spacings
Spacing in inches between centersof conduits for under slab stub-ups
Conduit Size ½ 3/4 1 1-1/4 1-1/2 2 2-1/2 3 4 4-1/2 5 63-1/2
½ 1-3/8 ____ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___3/4 1-1/2 1-5/8 --- ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___1 1-3/4 1-7/8 2 ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___
1-1/4 2 2-1/8 2-1/4 2-1/2 ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___1-1/2 2-1/8 2-1/4 2-3/8 2-5/8 2-3/4 ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___
2 2-3/8 2-1/2 2-3/4 3 3-1/8 3 ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___2-1/2 2-5/8 2-3/4 3 3-1/4 3-3/8 3-5/8 4 ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___
3 3 3-1/8 3-3/8 3-5/8 3-3/4 4 4-3/8 4-3/4 ___ ___ ___ ___ ___3-1/2 3-3/8 3-1/2 3-5/8 3-7/8 4 4-3/8 4-5/8 5 5-3/8 ___ ___ ___ ___
4 3-3/4 3-7/8 4 4-1/4 4-3/8 4-3/4 5 5-3/8 5-5/8 6 ___ ___ ___4-1/2 4 4-1/8 4-1/4 4-1/2 4-3/4 5 5-1/4 5-5/8 6 6-1/4 6-1/2 ___ ___
5 4-3/8 4-1/2 4-5/8 4-7/8 5 5-3/8 5-5/8 6 6-1/4 6-5/8 7 7-1/4 ___6 5 5-1/8 5-1/4 5-1/2 5-5/8 6 6-1/4 6-5/8 7 7-1/4 7-5/8 8 8-5/8
TABLE 4-147. Electrical Finish and Trim (Industrial)
Work Element DescriptionMan-Hours
Unit Per Unit
Connect Light Equipment EA 2.2 (9155) (Bench Tools, Table Mounted Galley Equipment) Connect Heavy Equipment EA 4.0 (9156) (Large Floor Mounted Machines and Galley Equipment) Motor Starters and Controls, Magnetic FVNR with Heaters and Enclosures 5 HHorsepower Size 0 EA 3.2 (9157) 10 Horse power, Size 1 EA 5.6 (9158) 25 Horsepower, Size 2 EA 10.4 (9159) 50 Horsepower, Size 3 EA 12.8 (9160) 100 Horsepower, Size 4 EA 21.6 (9161) Combination Starters, Magnetic FVNR with Circuit Breaker or Fused Switchand Heater EA 5.6 (9162) 5 Horsepower, Size 0 EA 8.0 (9163) 10 Horsepower, Size 1 EA 12.0 (9164) 25 Horsepower, Size 2 EA 15.2 (9165) 50 Horsepower, Size 3 EA 23.2 (9166) 100 Horsepower, Size 4 Control Stations, Heavy Duty Start and Stop EA 0.8 (9167) Start, Stop, and Pilot Light EA 1.6 (9168) Hand, Off, Automatic EA 1.6 (9169) Stop, Start, and Reverse EA 1.6 (9170)
Circuit Testing and Balance Three Phase Circuit EA 1.6 (9171)
SUGGESTED CREW SIZE: Two CEs
NOTE: 1. For combination reversing type controls use 1.2 multiplier.
4-142
TABLE 4-148. Substation Installation
Work Element Description Unit Man-HoursPer Unit
Install and Wire Complete Oil Filled Transformer 300 kVA and smaller EA 36.0 (9172) 500 kVA EA 60.0 (9173) 750 kVA EA 63.2 (9174) 1000 kVA EA 95.2 (9175)
Install and Wire Complete Three-Phase Dry-Type AirCooled Transformer in Vault or Building Up to 150 kVA EA 24.8 (9176) 151 kVA and larger EA 45.6 (9177)
Install Three-Phase Metal Clad Switch Gear Unit EA 16.0 (9178)
Install Oil Circuit Breakers (OCB) 100 to 600 Ampere, Single Circuit EA 8.4 (9179) 601 to 1200 Ampere, Single Circuit EA 24.0 (9180)
Install Open or Enclosed Disconnect Switches 100 Ampere and smaller. Single Circuit EA 8.8 (9181) 150 Ampere and larger. Single Circuit EA 12.8 (9182)
Install Air-Break Switches and Components 100 to 600 Ampere, Single Pole, Single Throw EA 8.8 (9183) 601 to 1200 Ampere, Single Pole, Single Throw EA 12.8 (9184)
Install Capacitor Bank with Associated Equipment 3 to 9 Capacitor Bank EA 27.2 (9185) 12 to 24 Capacitor Bank EA 42.4 (9186)
SUGGESTED CREW SIZE: Four CEs (two linemen and two groundmen)
4-143
TABLE 4-149. Fire Alarm and Signal Systems
Work Element Description Unit Man-HoursPer Unit
Burglar Alarm, Mechanical or Electrical EA 3.2 (9187)
Card Reader, Flush, Standard or Multi-Channel EA 4.0 (9188)
Door Switch, Hinged or Magnetic EA 2.4 (9189)
Exit Control Lock, Horn or Flashing Light EA 3.2 (9190)
Indication Panels 1 Channel EA 10 Channel EA 70 Channel EA
4.0 (9191) 6.4 (9192)14.4 (9193)
Ultrasonic Unit with Horn: 12, 24, or 120V EA 4.8 (9194)
Control Panel, Fire, Sprinkler and Stand Pipe 4 Zone EA 8 Zone EA 12 Zone EA
4.8 (9195)10.4 (9196)15.2 (9197)
Battery Rack EA 3.2 (9198)
Automatic Charger EA 2.4 (9199)
Signal Bell, Trouble Buzzer or Manual Station EA 1.6 (9200)
Detector, Rate of Rise or Fixed Temperature EA 1.6 (9201)
Smoke Detector Ceiling Type Duct Type
EAEA
1.6 (9202) 3.2 (9203)
Light and Horn EA 2.4 (9204)
Fire Alarm Horn EA 1.6 (9205)
Master Box EA 4.0 (9206)
Break Glass Station EA 1.6 (9207)
Remote Annunciator 8 Zone Drop 12 Zone Drop 16 Zone Drop
EAEAEA
5.6 (9208) 7.2 (9209) 8.8 (9210)
Standpipe or Sprinkler Alarm, Alarm Device EA 1.6 (9211)
Actuation Device EA 1.6 (9212)
Annunciator, Control and Indicator Panel EA 1.0 (9213)
Testing all other devices 5 EA 0.16 (9214)
SUGGESTED CREW SIZE: Two CEs
4-144
TABLE 4-150. Overhead Telephone Line Construction
Work Element Description Unit Man-HoursPer Unit
Install Messenger Suspension Clamps EA 0.16 (9252)
Attach Messenger to Suspension Clamps FT 0.032 (9253)
Splicing Overhead Cable (Straight Splice) Polyethylene Sheath and Insulation. 100 Pair Splice 5.6 (9254)
Terminating Cable at Terminal Box or Main Distribution Frame(Tag Splice) Polyethylene Sheath and Insulation. 100 Pair Splice 8.0 (9255)
SUGGESTED CREW SIZE: Two CEs (one lineman and one groundman)
TABLE 4-151. Interior Telephone Service
Work Element Description Unit Man-HoursPer Unit
Pull Cable in Conduit Polyethylene Sheath, 100 Pair FT 0.4 (9217)
Install Exposed Interior Cable, 26 Pair FT 0.32 (9218)
Install Telephone Terminal Box EA 2.4 (9219)
Install Polyethylene Cable Terminal, 26 Pair EA 1.6 (9220)
Connect Terminal Stub to Cable Polyethylene Sheath, 26 Pair EA 2.4 (9221)
Install Telephone, Complete, Any Style, 1 Line EA 3.2 (9222)
Splice Telephone Cable in Building, Vault, or Manhole Polyethylene Sheath Splice 5.6 (9223)
Testing EA 0.4 (9224)
SUGGESTED CREW SIZE: Two CEs
4-145
TABLE 4-152. Underground Telephone Line Construction
Work Element Description Unit Man-HoursPer Unit
Pull Cable in Duct or Conduit Polyethylene Sheath, 100 Pair FT 0.032 (9261)
Attach Lead of Polyethylene Cable Riser Direct to Concrete Wall FT 8.0 (9262)
Install 1 Inch to 6 Inch Conduit for Riser FT 8.0 (9263)
Pull Riser Cable into Installed Conduit FT 8.0 (9264)
SUGGESTED CREW SIZE: Three CEs
NOTE: 1. Refer to Table 4-17, Division 2, for estimating figures on Trench Excavation.
4-146
TABLE 4-153. Installing Intercommunication System
Work Element Description Unit Man-HoursPer Unit
Public Address System Conventional Office EA 2.4 (9228) Industrial EA 4.0 (9229)
Sound System Speakers, Ceiling or Wall Mounted EA 1.6 (9230) Speakers, Trumpt EA 3.2 (9231) Volume Control EA 1.6 (9232) Amplifier, 250 Watt EA 9.6 (9233) Cabinets EA 9.6 (9234)
Intercom, Master Up to 25 Station Capacity EA 9.6 (9235) Remote Station EA 1.6 (9236)
Emergency Call System 12 Zones, Annunciator EA 11.2 (9237) Bell EA 1.6 (9238) Light or Relay EA 1.6 (9239) Transformer EA 4.0 (9240)
House Telephone Talking Station EA 5.6 (9241) Press to Talk, Release to Listen EA 1.6 (9242)
Combination Speaker and Microphone EA 1.6 (9243)
Terminal Box EA 3.2 (9244)
Amplifier or Power Supply EA 4.8 (9245)
Annunciator, Master Intercom, and Amplifier EA 1.0 (9246)
Testing all other devices EA 0.16 (9247)
SUGGESTED CREW SIZE: Three CEs
4-147
DIVISION 17. EXPEDITIONARY STRUCTURESPage
A. TENSION FABRIC STRUCTURES Table 4-154 Tension Fabric Structures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-147
B. K - SPAN BUILDINGS Table 4-155 K - Span Buildings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-147
4-148
This page is blank
4-149
Table 4-154. Tension Fabric Structures
Frame and Shell Only
Structure Unit Manhours
Length (FT) Width (FT)
10 - 30 20 - 40 SF 0.42 (1701)
31 - 50 41 - 60 SF 0.32 (1702)
51 - 100 61 - 120 SF 0.4 (1703)
101 - 300+ 121 - 200+ SF 0.48 (1704)
Suggested Crew Size: One BU1, two SW, Six NS
NOTE: (1) These estimates are for frame and shell only.(2) Duckbill anchors furnished with basic TFS are for unpaved surface only. (3) For asphalt and concrete surfaces use expansion type anchors.(4) Refer to other sections of this P-405 for other estimates.
Table 4-155. K - Span Buildings
MIC-120 MIC-240Shell and End-Walls Only
Bldg. Width Unit Building Length Manhours
10 - 50 FT 0.6 (1705)
51 - 100+ FT 1.0 (1706)
Bldg. Width Unit End-Wall Length Manhours
10 - 50 FT 1.2 (1707)
51 - 100+ FT 2.0 (1708)
Suggested Crew Size: One SW MIC-120 MIC-240 certified, One EO crane certified, Eight NS.
NOTE: (1) This estimate is for shell and end-walls only.(2) For footings, utilities, and other components refer to other sections of this P-405.
4-150
This page is blank
5-1
CHAPTER 5. NETWORK ANALYSIS TECHNIQUES
1. HISTORY. Beginning in the post-World War II period, the construction industry found itselfunder the same critical examination the manufacturing industry had experienced 50 years previously.Large construction projects were coming under the same pressures of time, resources, and cost thathad prompted studies in scientific management in factories at the turn of the century.
The emphasis, however, was not on actual building methods, but upon the managementtechniques of programming and scheduling. The only planning methods were those which had beendeveloped for use in factories, and management attempted to use these for the control of largeconstruction projects. These techniques suffered from serious limitations as far as project work wasconcerned, and it was the need to overcome these limitations that led to the development of networkanalysis techniques.
In the late 1950's this new system of project planning, scheduling, and control came intowidespread use in the construction industry. Critical Path Analysis (CPA), Critical Path Method(CPM), and Project Evaluation and Review Techniques (PERT) are representative of about 50 titles.The basis of any of these approaches is the Analysis of a Network of Events and Activities. For thisreason, the generic title covering the various systems is "Network Analysis."
2. NETWORK ANALYSIS ADVANTAGES. The main advantages are listed below.
a. Separation of Sequence and Time. Network analysis separates the planning of thesequence of jobs from the scheduling of times for the jobs, thus overcoming simultaneous, and lesseffective, planning and scheduling.
b. Job Interdependency. The interdependencies between jobs are shown and thus itenables people to see not only the overall plan, but the ways in which their own activities depend upon,or influence, those of others.
c. View Complete Plan. Network analysis sets out the complete plan for examinationby everyone involved in the project, simplifies the task of assessing its soundness, and preventsunrealistic or superficial planning.
d. Resource and Time Restraints. Resource and time restraints are shown in the planbefore its evaluation. For example, a resource restraint is where several operations use a crane, butonly one is available. A minimum delivery period for materials is a time restraint.
e. Divides Projects into Activities. The analysis splits up the project into activities,assists in estimating their durations, and leads to a more accurate target date.
f. Project Duration. The shortest length of time (duration) in which a project can becompleted is determined, based upon the order and relationship of all activities.
5-2
g. Critical Activities Identified. Critical activities that must start on time to avoidextending the project duration are identified.
h. Deviation Controls. Stricter controls are permitted because any deviation fromthe schedule is quickly noticed.
I. Requirement Calculations. The total requirements of men, materials, andequipment resources are allowed to be readily calculated. The delaying or slowing down ofnoncritical jobs (those not immediately affecting the duration of the project) are indicated and maybe used to make the best allowance for any limitations in available resources.
j. Constant Logic Statement. The network is a statement of logic and policy andremains constant whether the activities take a longer or shorter time than estimated.
k. Modification Impact Assessment. Modifications of policy are allowed to be builtin, and the impact of these modifications can be assessed quickly.
l. Critical Path Identification. Identification of the critical path is advantageous ifthe completion date has to be advanced and attention can then be concentrated on speeding up therelatively few "critical" jobs.
m. Bar Chart Basis. A more accurate and effective basis for the preparation of barcharts is provided, which results in better control of projects.
3. NETWORK ANALYSIS DISADVANTAGES. The only real disadvantage of networkanalysis as a planning tools is that it is a tedious and exacting task if attempted manually.Depending upon just what the project manager wants as "output," the number of activities thatcan be handled without a computer varies, but it is never very high.
a. Manual Calculations. Calculations are done in terms of the sequence of activities,and if this is all that is required, a project that involves several hundred activities may beattempted manually. However, the possibility of error is high, and if the results are to be"sorted," for instance, by rate (so that all jobs to be undertaken by the builders are together, asthose for equipment operators, or electricians), the time of manual operation rapidly becomescostly. The consideration of various alternative plans also becomes impossible, because of thelarge volumes of calculations involved.
b. Computer Calculations. On the other hand, standard computer programs fornetwork analysis can handle project plans of 5,000 activities and more, and produce "output" invarious forms. It must be emphasized, however, that a computer only assists with thecalculations and prints plans of operations sorted into various orders. The project manager, notthe computer, is still responsible for the planning and must still make the necessary decisionsbased on information supplied by the computer. Equally important is the fact that the computeroutput is only as accurate as its input, which is supplied in the first instance by human beings.
5-3
4. PROJECT PLANNING. The basic rules in analyzing a project are that planning andscheduling are considered to be two distinctly separate operations, and that planning must alwaysprecede scheduling. When these two are done simultaneously they generally introduce elementsof scheduling prematurely, thus clouding the picture of the plan and severely limiting itsflexibility. The planning steps most commonly followed in the NCF are listed in appendix G.
a. Project Analysis. Everyone concerned should know precisely what the project is,its start and end points, external factors such as schedule dates and requirements of others, andavailability of resources such as men and equipment.
b. Activity List Development. All projects consist of separate but interrelatedoperations. In network analysis these are called "activities." The first stage in applying thistechnique is to obtain a list of all activities which constitute the project to be scheduled. This listis obtained in various ways: study of manufacturers' specifications; bills of materials andtechnical drawings; modification of a previous application; worksheets for a previous project;and a joint discussion by those persons who sufficiently understand the project. The last methodshould be employed even if a tentative list has been obtained by other means. These are nospecific definitions as to what constitutes an "activity," and it is largely a matter for individualinterpretation according to the requirement of a particular project. A useful guideline is to askthree questions about any particular activity in the network. (These are simply useful pointers,not infallible rules).
(1) Would the activity normally be regarded as continuous from start to finish?This does not mean that it may not prove expedient to split the activity later to facilitatescheduling. The key here is the word "normally."
(2) Will the required resources remain constant throughout the duration of theactivity? In certain circumstances this may not be achievable but facilitates control if it can bedone.
(3) Is the amount of work involved small enough to allow a reliable durationestimate to be assigned to the activity?
No attempt should be made to minimize the number of activities in a network by leavingout those considered to be unimportant and to have considerable float. They can easily beforgotten and their omission could lead to an entirely false analysis. A good rule is, don't plana project in any more detail than is necessary to properly manage the scheduling of the workduring the construction phase. The reason for this is to avoid being overwhelmed by a lot ofdetailed items of work that will change faster then the planner has time to adjust or plan for. Formost NCF projects, detailed activities should not be less than one day in duration (preferably notless than three days). One further point to remember; there may be space limitations in thecomputer for activity descriptions. Each activity should be given a fairly concise title which willidentify it in the computer printout.
ACTIVITYNUMBER
ACTIVITYDURATION
EARLYSTART
LATESTART
EARLYFINISH
LATEFINISH
ACTIVITYDESCRIPTION
ACTIVITYRESOURCES
TOTALFLOAT
FREEFLOAT
5-4
c. Network Construction. A "network" is used to represent any sequencing of priorities among the activities that constitute a project. This sequencing is determined by twotypes of dependency.
(1) "Hard" dependencies are those which are based upon the physicalcharacteristics of the job such as the necessity to place a foundation before building walls. A harddependency is normally inflexible.
(2) "Soft" dependencies are those which are based upon practical considerationsof policy and may be changed if circumstances demand. For example, the decision to start at thenorth end of a building rather than the south.
5. PRECEDENCE DIAGRAMING. In constructing networks the NCF uses PrecedenceDiagraming. A Precedence Network derives its name from the fact that each activity is identifiedin a computer program in terms of its immediately preceding and succeeding activities.Precedence Diagraming does not require the use of dummy activities, is easier to draw, and hasgreater applications and advantages when Networks are put into the computer.
a. Activities and Events Representation. An activity in a Precedence Diagram isrepresented by a rectangular box and is identified by an activity number. A typical activity blockis shown in figure 5-1. The left side of the activity box represents the start of the activity and theright side represents the completion. Lines linking the boxes are called "logic connectors" andthe general direction of flow is indicated by arrowheads.
FIGURE 5-1. Typical Activity Block
1
2
3
5-5
The rule that governs the drawing of a network is that the start of an activity must belinked to the ends of all completed activities before that start may take place. Activities that takeplace at the same time are not linked in any way. In figure 5-2 both activity 2 and activity 3 startas soon as activity 1 is completed. Activity 4 requires the completion of both activities 2 and 3before it may start. Figure 5-2 shows a finish to start Logic Relationship. This is the mostcommon relationship used in the NCF.
FIGURE 5-2. Precedence Diagram
b. Delay Representation. In certain cases there may be a delay or lag between thefinish of one activity and the start of another. In this case the lag may be indicated on theconnector itself incased in parenthesis as has been done in figure 5-3. Here, activity 3 may startas soon as activity 1 is completed, but activity 2 must wait two days. The "lag" is stated in thebasic time units of the project, in which case the word "days" can be omitted.
FIGURE 5-3. Representation of Lag
1 2
3
(1)
1
2 3
(1)
5-6
c. Parallel Activities Representation. Some activities may parallel other which canbe achieved in precedence diagrams without increasing the number of activities. For instance,it is possible to start laying a long pipeline before excavations are complete. This is known asa start-to-start Logic connection, as shown in figure 5-4. Activity 3 cannot start until one dayafter activity 1 has started.
FIGURE 5-4. Start-to-Start Logic Connection
It is also possible to start an activity independently, but not to complete it before anotheractivity is completed. This is known as a finish-to-finish logic connection, as shown in figure 5-5. Activity 3 cannot be completed until one day after activity 1 is completed.
Care should be taken in using either of these logic connections. If possible, the Finish-to-Start Connection should be used for all NCF planning.
FIGURE 5-5. Finish-to-Finish Logic Connection
5-7
6. PRECEDENCE NETWORK CALCULATIONS. Precedence networks are the primaryproject scheduling tools used in the NCF. The scheduling of any construction activity isdependent on the duration of the construction activities that precede it. The forward pass, thebackward pass, and float calculations are the basis to form the construction schedule.
a. Definitions
(1) The Forward Pass determines the Early Start and Early Finish of an activity. The earliest date that an activity can be started and finished based on the durations of activitiesthat precede it. It determines the total project duration based on the sum of the activity durationsalong the longest path through the project.
Calculations:
Early Start + Duration = Early FinishEarly Finish + Lag (if any) = Early Start (of next activity)
NOTE: With two or more predecessors, use the LARGER of the two Early Finish + Lagdates.
(2) The Backward Pass determines Late Start and Late Finish of an activity. Thelatest that each activity can start and finish without delaying the total project duration calculatedon the Forward Pass.
Calculations:
Late Finish - Duration = Late StartLate Start - Lag (if any) = Late Finish (preceding activity)
NOTE: With two or more follow-on activities, use the SMALLER of the Late Start - Lagdates.
(3) The Critical Path is those activities whose early start/early finish and latestart/late finish dates match. The critical activities form a critical path from the first activity tothe last.
(4) Total Float is the total number of days an activity can be delayed withoutdelaying the completion date of the project, and allows a crew leader or project supervisor thediscretion to start an activity anywhere between the early and late start dates without delaying thecompletion date of the project.
Larger #Forward Pass
Backward Pass
Total Float
Free Float
(Early Datets)
(Late Datets)
(Early Datets)
Smaller #
Smaller #
5-8
Calculations:
Total Float = Late Start - Early Start or Late Finish- Early Finish
NOTE: The total float for critical activities is always zero since the Early and Late Startand Finish dates are the same. Therefore, Total Float is calculated for non-critical activities only.
(5) Free Float is the number of days an activity can be delayed without delayingthe next activity from its Early Start or the number of days of Float that can be used withouttaking Float from another activity.
All or a portion of the Total Float may be shared with follow-on activities. If Float is notshared with a follow-on activity, it is free. Using Free Float does not take Float away fromfollow-on activities nor does it delay the next activity from its Early Start date.
Calculations:
Free Float = Early Start (next activity) - Lag (if any) - Early Finish
NOTE: With two or more follow-on activities use the smaller of the early start - lag.
b. Calculation Sequence
NOTE: All the calculations in a. and b. above are based on finish to start logic connectors.
c. Sample Calculations. Figures 5-6 through 5-10 show sample calculations.Equations marked with an asterisk (*) change with different types of logic. General Rule: alwaysfollow the logic connector!
5-9
Early Start + Duration = Early Finish *Early Finish + Lag (if any) = Early Start (next activity)
Use largest of the (Early Finish + Lag) with two or mor e predecessors
FIGURE 5-6. The Forward Pass
Late Finish - Duration = Late Start * Late Start - Lag (if any) = Late Finish (preceding activity) Use smallest of the (late Start - Lag) with two or more follo w on activities.
FIGURE 5-7. The Backward Pass
2010 3
12
14
15
172 0
(2)
2020 4
14
16 20
18
2
5-10
Total Float = Late Start - Early Start or Late Finish - Early Finish * Free Float = Early Start (next activity) - Lag - Early Finish NOTE: With two or more follow on activities use the smaller o f
Early Start - Lag
FIGURE 5-8. Floats
Equations shown for the following Logic Connections are the ones that change fromFinish-to-Start Logic Connection. All other equations remain the same.
Forward Pass: Early Start + Lag = Early Start (next activity)Backwards Pass: Late Start - Lag = Late Start (preceding activity)Free Float = Early Start (next activity) - Lag - Early Start
FIGURE 5-9. Start-to-Start
2010 3
12
14
15
172 0
2020 4
14
16 20
18
2
(2)
5-11
Forward Pass: Early Finish + Lag = Early Finish (next activity)Backwards Pass: Late Finish - Lag = Late Finish (preceding activity)Free Float = Early Finish (next activity) - Lag - Early Finish
FIGURE 5-10. Finish-to-Finish
5-12
NOTE: ACTIVITIES IN THE NETWORK ARENUMBERED FROM LEFT TO RIGHT ANDFROM TOP TO BOTTOM. WHENACTIVITIES ARE ADDED OR DELETED INTHE NETWORK IT WILL BE NECESSARYTO RECALCULATE THE EARLY STARTAND EARLY FINISH TIMES THROUGH THENETWORK. THEN, WORK BACK MAKINGTHE REQUIRED ADJUSTMENTS TO THELATE FINISH AND LATE START. THISADJUSTMENT SHOULD BE MADE AT THEEARLIEST OPPORTUNITY TO FACILITATETHE COMPUTER UPDATE
FIGURE 5-11.Typical Precedence Diagram for 40- by 100-foot rigid frame building
5-13
7. COMPUTER USE IN THE NCF. The usefulness of the computer as a constructionmanagement tool for the Naval Construction Force was first tested in September 1976 during thedeployment of NMCB-3 to Diego Garcia. The results were encouraging and the decision wasmade to install a minicomputer system at each of the permanent deployment sites, each homeportregiment, CBLANT, and the Civil Engineer Support Office (CESO). In 1982 the Navypurchased an improved version of the original software package for construction management,CM-5. In 1983 the Seabee Automated Mobile Management (SAMM) system was approved bythe Chief of Naval Operations (CNO). CESO procured and distributed over 1,000microcomputers (also referred to as personal computers or PC) to NCF units. Microtrakreplaced CM-5 in 1986. Microtrak is a commercial software package for use with themicrocomputer. In 1996 CBCM2 software replaced Microtrack.
5-14
This page is blank.
5-15
CHAPTER 6. CBCM2 USER MANUAL
THE MANUAL WILL BE INSERTED AT LATER DATE
5-16
This page is blank
Glossary-1
GLOSSARY
ABFC Advanced Base Functional ComponentABS Acrylonitrile-Butadiene-Styrene (plastic pipe)ASSY AssemblyAVG AverageAWD Available Work DayAWG American Wire GageBBL BarrelBLDG BuildingBM Bill of MaterialBTU British Thermal UnitBU BuilderCAS Construction Activity SummaryCE Construction ElectricianCFM Cubic Feet per MinuteCM Construction MechanicCMU Concrete Masonry UnitCN ConstructionmanCONST ConstructionCPVC Chlorinated Polyvinyl Chloride (plastic pipe)C to C Center to CenterCTR Central Tool Roomd Penny (British pence). Size for a nailDIA DiameterDWG DrawingEA Engineering AidELEC ElectricEMT Electrical Metal TubingEO Equipment OperatorFEDSTRIP Federal Standard Requisitioning and Issue ProceduresFY Fiscal YearGED Gasoline-engine DrivedGMA Gas Metal ArcGPM Gallons per MinuteGTA Gas Tungsten ArcHoriz HorizontalHP HorsepowerID Inside DiameterImc Intermediate Metal ConduitIN Inch or N
Glossary-2
GLOSSARY
kV KilovoltkVA Kilovolt-AmpereLTG LightingLCD Loose Cubic YardMATL MaterialM/D Man-Days (8 hours)MILSTRIP Military Standard Requisitioning and Issue ProceduresMLO Material Liaison OfficeMPH Miles per HourMTO Material Take OffNCFSU Naval Construction Force Support UnitNS Non-SkilledOF-13 Occupational Field 13 (Seabee rates)PERF PerforatePVC Polyvinyl Chloride (plastic pipe)PH PhaseQC Quality ControlRCPT RecepticalREBAR Reinforcing BarREINF ReinforceRST Reinforcing SteelSFCS Square Feet Contact SurfaceSITREPS Situation ReportsSQ Square (100 square feet)SQ IN Square InchSW Steel WorkerTA Table of Allowance (same as TOA)T&G Tongue and GrooveTHKNS ThicknessTM Technical ManualTOA Table of AllowanceTON MI Tons per MileTPH Tons per HourU/I Units of IssueUT UtilitiesmanW/O WithoutYD MI Yards per Mile
Glossary-3
UNITS OF ISSUE. The designations shown are used to denote the units of issue and should be used on allFEDSTRIP/MILSTRIP requisitions.
AM Ampoule LB PoundAT Assortment LG LengthAY Assembly LI LiterBA Ball MFBM 1000 Board feet measureBD Bundle MC Thousand cubic feetBE Bale ME MealBF Board foot MR Mete rBG Bag MX ThousandBK Book OT OutfitBL Barrel OZ OunceBO Bolt PD PadBR Bar PG PackageBT Bottle PM PlateBX Box PR PairCA Cartridge PT PintCB Carboy PZ PacketCD Cubic yard QT QuartCE Cone RA RationCF Cubic foot RL ReelCK Cake RM ReamCL Coil RO RollCN Can SD SkidCO Container SE SetCT Carton SF Square footCY Cylinder SH SheetCZ Cubic meter SK SkeinDR Drum SL SpoolDZ Dozen SO ShotEA Each SP StripFT Foot (feet) SX StickGL Gallon SY Square yardGP Group TN TonGR Gross TO Troy ounceHD Hundred TU TubeHK Hank VI VialIN Inch YD Yard JR JarKT Kit
Glossary-4
This page is blank.
Bibliography-1
BIBLIOGRAPHY
A. CIVILIAN PUBLICATIONS
Means, Robert S. Building Construction Cost Data, 52nd edition, Kingston, MA. R. S. Means Co., Inc., 1994
Walker, Frank R. The Building Estimators Reference Books, 24th edition, Lisle, IL.Frank R. Walker Co., Inc., 1992
Richardson Engineering Services, Inc., Residential and Light Construction Estimating andEngineering Standards, Vol.3, Mesa, AZ, Richardson Engineering Services, Inc., 1994
Nichols, Herbert L., Jr., "Moving the Earth," The Workbook of Excavation, 3rd edition, NewYork, NY, McGraw Hill Information Systems, 1988
Asphalt Institute, The Asphalt Handbook, Manual Series No. 4 (MS-4), April 1965 edition,Lexington KY, Asphalt Institute, 1989
Conwed Corporation, Conwed Hydromulch Pamphlet, Form No. 635-127L, St. Paul, NM,Conwed Corp.
E. D. Etnyre and Co., Koppers Tarmac Handbook, Black Topper Computer, 4th edition,Oregon, IL, E. D. Etnyre and Co. (EDECO)
Caterpiller Tractor Co., Fundamentals of Earthmoving, May 1965 Revision, Peoria, IL,Caterpillar Tractor Co.
National Fire Protecting Association, National Electric Code, NFPA No. 70, 1993 edition,National Fire Protection Association, Quincy, MA
Concrete Reinforcing Steel Institute, Reinforcing Bar Detailing, CRSI, 3rd edition, Kingsport,TN, Kingsport Press, Inc., 1988
International Association of Plumbing and Mechanical Officials, Uniform Plumbing Code, 1988
Masonry Institute of America, Volume of Grout Required in Masonry Walls, Design Aid 15,Masonry Institute of America, Los Angeles, CA, 1971
Bibliography-2
B. MILITARY PUBLICATIONS U. S. ARMY
U. S. Army Corps of Engineers, Field Fortifications, FM 5-15, 1968
U. S. Army Corps of Engineers, Management: Utilization of Engineer ConstructionEquipment, TM 5-331, 1967
U. S. Army Corps of Engineers, Earth Moving and Compaction, Grading and DitchingEquipment, TM 5-331A, 1967
U. S. Army Corps of Engineers, Lifting, Loading, and Hauling Equipment, TM 5-331B, 1968
U. S. Army Corps of Engineers, Rock Crushers, Air Compressors, and Pneumatic Tools, TM 5-331C, 1968
U. S. Army Corps of Engineers, Construction Management, TM 5-333, 1972
U. S. Army Corps of Engineers, Drainage Structures, Sub Grades and Base Courses, TM 5-335, 1972
U. S. NAVY
Naval Facilities Engineering Command, Electric/Electronic Handbook, Engineered PerformanceStandards, NAVFAC P-703.0, 1990
Naval Facilities Engineering Command, Facilities Engineering-Electrical Exterior Facilities,NAVFAC MO-200, 1979
Naval Facilities Engineering Command, Wire Communications and Signal Maintenance, MIL-HDBK-1004/7, 1991
Naval Facilities Engineering Command, Facilities Planning Guide, (Vol.1 drawings, Vol.2material list) NAVFAC P-437, 1992
Naval Facilities Engineering Command, Unit Price Standards Handbook, NAVFAC P-716, 1983
U. S. Construction Battalions, Pacific Command/ U.S. Construction Battalions, AtlanticCommand, Naval Construction Forces Safety Manual, COMCBPAC/COMCBLANTInstruction 5100.1F
Naval School, Civil Engineer Corps Officers, Naval Mobile Construction Battalion CrewleadersHandbook, Sept. 1992
A-1
APPENDIX A
Work Element Checklist
A-2
This page is blank
A-3
WORK ELEMENT CHECKLISTArranged in Work Sequence
A. STRUCTURES
Remove existing structuresClearing and grubbingBlastingGradingFill, place, and compactLandscape, seed, sodExcavation and backfillConcrete foundations and footingsPipe sleevesUnder-floor conduit and plumbingTransformer vaultGrade beamsGround floor slabConcrete columns, beams, girdersConcrete floor and roof slabsPrecast wall and roof panelsPrecast structural membersPrecast sills and lintelsConcrete canopy and entrancesTreads and nosingsPipe sleeves and openingsAlarm system: burglar, fireElectric service
Structural steelMasonry: concrete glock, brick, structural tileFlashingFraming floors, walls, roofs, stairsSheathing walls and roofSubflooringDoor bucks and frames: woodDoor bucks and frames: metalWindow framesConduit in slabs and wallsPiping in wallsElectrical rough-inPlumbing rough-in
A-4
A. STRUCTURES (Continued)
Siding: woodSiding and roofing: metalHoods and ventilatorsInsulation, roof
RoofingAsphalt or wood shinglesDuctworkIntercom systemTelephone switchboard equipmentTile flooring: asphalt, rubber, vinyl, corkAcoustical tileInterior trim
HandrailsCaulkingTelephone servicewallboardLathingStairwaysStuds and partitions: metalInsulation, walls, and ceilingsDown spouts and guttersFire escapeLaddersPlatforms and catwalksRoof scuttlesDoors: exteriorDoors: screenWindowsWindow screensJalousiesExterior trimGlazingLouversCabinetsCloset unitsLockersBulletin boards
A-5
A. STRUCTURES (Continued)
Mirrors and medicine cabinetsPanelingDoor: interiorDoors: metalToilet partitions: metal
Security grillsPlasteringCeramic tile
PaintingCurbs and walksParking areasFencingCleanupAir conditioningCompressed air systemsDehumidifiersDry cleaning equipmentExhaust fansFire protection systemsGeneratorsHeating systemLaundry equipmentPumpsRefrigeratorsShop equipmentVentilation equipmentGalley equipmentWater coolersHospital equipmentElectric fixturesPlumbing fixturesFinish flooring
B. OUTSIDE UTILITIES
Clearing and grubbingBlastingTrenching and ditching
A-6
B. OUTSIDE UTILITIES (Continued)
Backfill and compactErosion controlWater mainsWater service linesSanitary sewer mainsSanitary sewer service linesValvesValve boxesManholesWater storage tanksWater pumpsSewage pumpsStorm sewers and manholesCatch basinsCulverts
Culvert head and wing wallsSewage treatment plantsPolesCableTransformersTelephone cableUnderground ductConduit risersManholes and handholesStreet LightsSecurity lightsControl devicesCapacitors and voltage regulators
C. PLANT OPERATIONS
Stripping quarryDrilling and blastingHandling and loading quarried materialHauling to crusher or jobSetting up crusher plantOperating crusherStockpiling crushed materialHauling crushed material to plants or job
A-7
C. PLANT OPERATIONS (continued)
Setting up asphalt plantOperating asphalt plantHauling asphalt to jobSetting up concrete batch plantHauling concrete to jobManufacturing concrete block: all sizesManufacturing precast concrete units: all typesHauling precast units to jobReinforcing steel fabricationManufacturing doors, windows, jalousies, louversManufacturing stairs, cabinets, closet unitsManufacturing concrete pipe
D. ROADS, PAVING, AND WALKS
Clearing and grubbingBlastingCut and fillGradingTrenching and ditchingMove and change interfering utilitiesCulvertsHead and wing wallsCatch basinsStorm drainagePrepare baseFine gradingErosion controlAsphalt tack coatSpread and roll asphaltic concreteSpread and roll chip and gravel coatsConcrete paving formsReinforcing steel and dowelsExpansion and contraction jointsFinishing and curingConcrete curbs completeConcrete walks completeAsphalt curbs completeAsphalt erosion protectionAsphalt walks completePrecast curbs installed
A-8
E. WATERFRONT CONSTRUCTION
Sheet pilingPile dolphinsPier pilingPile cappingPier cappingPier framingPier deckingPier deck hardwarePile extractionTiebacks and deadmanSeawallsDredging
A-9
This page is blank
B-1
APPENDIX B
Equipment and Tool Kit Description
(NMCB TOA-01, TOA-02Power Tools and Naval Construction Force Support Unit Kits)
B-2
This page is blank
B-3
EQUIPMENT AND TOOL KIT DESCRIPTIONS
This appendix contains equipment and tool kit descriptions for those kits found in theNaval Construction Battalion Table of Allowance (NMCB TOA-01). These descriptions arebriefs of the kit capabilities and the number of personnel it has been designed to support. Dueto frequent updates of kit items, a list of contents is not practical. Kit descriptions arepresented by their section and numerical sequence as listed in the NMCB TOA-01 followed byassembly numbers which support the basic capabilities.
A complete list of content, stock numbers, and costs are found in the NMCB TOA-01,or are available from:
Commanding OfficerCode 1571Naval Construction Battalion Center1000 23rd AvenuePort Hueneme, CA 93043-4301
B-4
This page is blank
B-5
TABLE OF ALLOWANCE (TA01)
Assembly Kit Name 80001 Plumbers (for four men)80002 Plumbers Shop80003 Tank Erection (for four men)80004 Gas Cutting and Welding Rig80005 Service Refrigeration80006 Electricians Tools (for two men)80007 Linemans Tools (for two men)80010 Surveyors Equipment80011 Draftsman (for three men)80019 Carpenters Tools (for four men)80024 Electric Arc Welding Accessories, 300 AMP80026 Soils80029 20 X 48 and 40 X 100 Rigid Frame Erection Tools80042 No-Skive Hose and Crimp Fitting80078 Hot Line Tools Electrical80087 Electronic Distance Measuring System80096 Welding Gas Tungsten Arc80119 Installation for Concertina Fencing80125 Saw Filing and Blade Sharpening80514 Alfa Co. Shops Support Operating Space Items82001 Saw Chain GED 18N82002 Set Paving Breaker Tamler Driver/Drill82011 Wrench Set IMP Pneumatic 1DR SCKTS 3/4 to 3-1/882012 Hammer, Scaling, Pneumatic82015 Drill, Electric Portable, 3/482016 Saw, Circular, Portable 7-1/4 Electric82019 Grinder/Sander, Electric Portable 7N82020 Wrench Set, IMP, Pneumatic, 1/2 DR. SCKTS with Accessories82021 Borer, Wood, Pneumatic Port 1-1/482023 Saw, Reciprocating, Horizontal, Portable82025 Hammer, Pneumatic Portable, Nail DR. DD-160 CAxxxxxxxxxx82026 Hammer, Nail, Pneumatic, 20-60D82031 Drill, Electric, Portable, 1/282033 Hammer, Pneumatic, Portable, Riveting with Chisels82036 Paving Breaker Set, Portable, Pneumatic, 80 lb.82038 Saw, Circular, Steel, Concrete, 12N GED82039 Tamper, Pneumatic, 6N Butt, 48 lb.82050 Tamper, Vibrating, Portable, Hammer Set, 4.2 HP83001 Miscellaneous Construction Tools83002 Miscellaneous "B" Company Equipment83069 Security Fence Installation (Tool Suplement)83070 Linemans Supplemental Tools84000 Miscellaneous Rigging Gear84007 Well Completion Kit (Water) 1500 Ft.85100 Portable Scales for Load Planning/Mountout
B-6
TABLE OF ALLOWANCE (TA02)
Assembly Augment Kit Name 80009 Welding GMA80020 Mason Tools (for four men)80021 Sheet Metal Tools80022 Wire Rope Splicing Tools80028 Quarrying and Demolition Equipment80032 Drywall Installation Tools80037 Overhead Power Line Conductor Installation80038 Plastering Tools (for four men)80039 Ceramic Tile Tools80047 Laserplane Surveying System80051 Pioneer and Rigging Tools80055 Cast Iron Pipe Installation (for four men)80056 Concrete Placement80065 Power Installed Screen Anchor and Accessories80066 Built-Up Roofing80088 Power Threading80097 Arcair Cutting and XXXXXXXXX, Electric80110 Planning and Estimating (P&E)80121 Asbestos Removal Protective Clothing Material80127 Concrete Testing (Supplement Kit 80026)80128 Asphalt Testing (Supplement Kit 80026)80140 Conduit Installation, 0.5 to 2N, EMT,IMC Rigid80141 Conduit Bending, 0.5 to 2N, EMT, 0.5 to 1.5 IMC80142 Conduit Cutting and Threading, 2.5 to 6N80143 Conduit Bending, 1.25 to 4N, EMT, IMC, Rigid80144 Conduit Bending, 1.25 to 4N, One Shot, 2.580145 PVC Conduit Installation, 0.5 thru 6N80146 Knockout for Conduits, 0.5 thru 5n80147 Vacuum Fishtape System, 0.5 to 6N Conduits80148 Wire Installation, Light Duty80149 Wire/Cable Puller, Heavy Duty EMD82003 Auger Earth GED, Portable82004 Drill, Pneumatic, Sinker, 55 Lb.82005 Screed, Vibratory, Concrete, GED, 3 HP82007 Vibrator, Concrete, Electric Motor Drive, 1 HP, 1N82008 Finishing Machine, Concrete, Rotary, GED82009 Spray Paint Outfit with Compressor, 1 Qt.82013 Saw, Circular, Pneumatic, 1282017 Saw, Circular, Portable 8-1/4N, Double Insulated82022 Drivers, Powder Actuated, Low Velocity82024 Drill, Hand, Portable, 1/2 GED82032 Wrench Set, IMP, Electrical, 1/2 DR with Accessories82034 Plane, Electrical, Portable, 2-1/2N82035 Sander, OSCIL, Electrical, Portable, High Speed
B-7
TABLE OF ALLOWANCE (TA02) (Continued)
Assembly Augment Kit 82037 Sander, Belt, Electrical, Portable, 3N82040 Door Hanging, with Electric Plane and Router82041 Mixer, Dual Purpose, Concrete and Mortar, 6CF82042 Cutter, Rebar, Hydraulic-Electric, 3/4 CAP82047 Drill, Electric, Portable, 3/8 Heavy Duty, Variable Speed82051 Rotary Hammer, Electric, for Concrete82058 Saw, Abrasive, Disc, Masonry, Block/Brick, 20N82059 Vibrator, Concrete, Electric Motor Driven, 3 HP82060 Vibrator, Concrete, Pneumatic, 1-3/8N, Round Head82064 Drill, 3/4N, H/D, REV, with magnetic Base Press82066 Compressor, 15 CFM, with Hose Kit82067 Welder, Arc, 300 AMP, Electric Rectifier82068 Welder Kit, Plastic, Portable, for PVC and ABS82072 Saw, Radial Arm, Portable, EMD, 15 and 18N82500 Miscellaneous Electrical Test Equipment83037 Supplemental Tools, Material, for Peacetime
B-8
TABLE OF ALLOWANCE OTHER ASSEMBLIES
Assembly TA Miscellaneous Kit Name 80018 TA10 Kit, Plumbers Shop, CBU80027 TA13/19 Kit, Railroad Tools80035 TA13/16 Support materials for Line construction80036 TA13 Kit, Tool, Lead Cable, Splicing F/2 Men80041 TA13/19 Kit, Heavy Timber Constr. Tools F/4 Men80046 ABFC Kit, Snow Removal Tools80054 TA10 Kit, Materials Testing (Smoke)80063 TA04 Kit, Construction Tools, Mini80064 TA04 Kit, Engineering Aid, Mini80152 TA55/56 Safety Support Equip/Mat'l Stored81007 TA70 Kit, Misc. Tools, Wrenches, Shovels, Hand82006 TA10/13/19/29/44Tamper, Vibrating, Port, 4HP, GED82010 TA10 Saw, Circular Table and Accessories82014 TA13 Drill, Pneu, Port 7/882018 TA13 Hammer, Mail, Pneu 60D 3/882043 TA13/56 Wrench, Elec, Impact 1/2 DR ADJ Torque82045 TA03/6/9 Driver, Powder Actuated Micro Kit82049 TA13 Screed Vibratory. Twin Beam, GED 21FT82073 TA70 Gen. Set,GED,Port.5kW,120V,60HZ,42AMPS82501 TA29 Misc. Electronics Test Equipment, F/RSA82502 TA10 Misc. Electronic Test Equipment82504 TA45/50 100-Man Det Misc. Elec. Test Equip.83006 TA03 Electricians Equipment and Supplies83007 TA03 Builders Equipment and Supplies83008 TA03 Utilitiesman Equipment and Supplied83009 TA03 Steelworkers Equipment and Supplied83010 TA03 Surveyors Equipment and Supplies83014 TA13 Misc. "B" Company Equipment83023 TA65/66 Carpenter Shop Equipment83024 TA45/50 100-Man Det Misc. Construction Tools83035 TA10 Misc. Tools/Equipment83039 TA65/66 Steel Shop Equipment83041 TA09 Misc. "B" Company Material for RSA83043 TA09/13/29 Misc. Construction Tools and Equipment83044 TA09/13 Misc "A" Company Equipment for RSA83059 TA19/42 Misc. "B" Company Material83077 TA10 Misc. Shop Equipment, Bravo Company83079 TA13 NMCB-Load Bank Gen. Test 5/250 kW85002 ABFC Kit, Camp Maint. Tools and Consumables85003 TA13/63/64 Kit, Valve Reconditioning Tools85014 TA10/13 Scaffold, Port. 2 inch Aluminum with 8 inch
B-9
85017 ABFC Slings/Rope/Blocks85018 ABFC Saw, Woodworking, Circular85019 ABFC Saw, Woodworking, Circular and Radial85025 TA13 Saw, Chain, 36N, GED, 2 Man85036 ABFC Rapid Runway Repair Tools F/AM2 Matting85037 ABFC Rapid Runway Repair Tools F/Fiber Glass,
Reinf.90006 TA13 Clothing, Desert Support for 100-Men Det.
B-10
POWER TOOLS Assembly Kit Name 82001 Saw, Chain, GED, 18n82002 Set Paving Breaker, Tamper DR82011 Wrench Set, IMP, Pneumatic, 1 DR SCKTS82012 Hammer, Scaling, Pneumatic82015 Drill, Electric, Portable, 3/482016 Saw, Circular, Portable, 7-1/4N82019 Grinder/Sander, Electric, Portable, 782020 Wrench Set, IMP, Pneumatic, 1/2 DR, SCKT82021 Borer, Wood, Pneumatic, Portable, 1-1/482023 Saw, Reciprocating, Horizontal, P82025 Hammer, Pneumatic, Portable, Nail DR, 6D-1682026 Hammer, Pneumatic, Nail 20-60D82031 Drill, Electrical, Portable, 1/282033 Hammer, Pneumatic, Portable Drive82036 Paving Breaker Set, Portable, Pneumatic, 80 Lb.82038 Saw, Circular, Steel-Concrete, 12N, GED82039 Tamper, Pneumatic, 6N Butt, 48 Lb.82050 Tamper, Vibraaating, Portable, Rammer
B-11
NAVAL CONSTRUCTION FORCE SUPPORT UNIT KITS Assembly Kit Name 80027 Railroad Tools80035 Support Materials for Line Construction/Maintenance Vehicle80036 Tool, Lead Cable Splicing (for two men)80041 Heavy Timber Construction (for four men)82006 Tamper, Vibrating, Portable, 4 HP, GED82014 Drill, Pneumatic, Portable, 7/882018 Hammer, Nail, Pneumatic, 60D, 3/882043 Wrench, Electric, Impact, 1/2 Drive82049 Screed, Vibratory, Twinbeam, GED, 21 Ft.83014 Miscellaneous "B" Company Equipment83079 NMCB Load Bank Gen. Test 5/250 kW85003 Valve Reconditioning Tools85014 Scaffold, Portable, 2-inch Aluminum85025 Saw, Chain, 36N, GED, (for two men)
B-12
This page is blank
C-1
APPENDIX C
Conversion and Waste Factors
C-2
This page is blank
C-3
TABLE C-1. Conversion and Waste Factors
Material Conversion % Waste
CONCRETE CONSTRUCTIONConcrete (1:2:4) Cement 6.0 SK/CD 10 Fine aggregate 0.6 CD/CD 10 Coarse aggregate 1.0 CD/CD 10
Curing Compound 0.5 GL/100 SF 10
Forms: Footings and Piers 2 X 4 1.5 FT/SFCS 20 2 X 8 0.2 FT/SFCS 10 2 X 12 0.7 FT/SFCS 5
Forms: Ground Slabs 1 X 4 0.1 FT/SF area 20 2 X 4 0.1 FT/SF area 5
Forms: Walls and Columns 2 X 4 1.3 FT/SFCS 20 Plywood (50% reuse) 0.5 SF/SFCS 5
Forms: Beams and Suspension Slabs 1 X 6 0.3 FT/SFCS 5 2 X 4 0.5 FT/SFCS 20 2 X 10 0.1 FT/SFCS 10 4 X 4 0.4 FT/SFCS 5 4 X 6 0.1 FT/SFCS 5 Plywood 0.5 SF/SFCS 5 Form oil 0.5 GL /100 SF 10 Tie wire 12.0 LB/TN 10 Snap tie wedges 0.1 EA/SFCS 5 Snap ties 0.1 EA/SFCS 5 She bolts 0.1 SE/SFCS 5 Nails (bf lumber + sf plywood, ordered as mfbm) 6d box 6 LB/MFBM 10 8d common 4 LB/MFBM 10 16d common 6 LB/MFBM 10 20d common 2 LB/MFBM 10 6d duplex 4 LB/MFBM 10 8d duplex 9 LB/MFBM 10 16d duplex 9 LB/MFBM 10 Trim 6d finish 7 LB/1000 FT 10 8d finish 14 LB/1000 FT 10
C-4
TABLE C-1. Conversion and Waste Factors (Continued)
Material Conversion % Waste
CONCRETE CONSTRUCTION (Continued)Reinforcing Steel #3 0.4 LB/FT 10 #4 0.7 LB/FT 10 #5 1.0 LB/FT 10 #6 1.5 LB/FT 10 #7 2.0 LB/FT 10 #8 2.7 LB/FT 10
Lumber Framing ____ 15 Sheathing ____ 25 Flooring ____ 25 Roofing ____ 25 Wallboard ____ 15 Trim ____ 10
STEEL ERECTIONRivets 25 EA/TN 10
Bolts (field) Temporary 5 EA/TN 5 Permanent 25 EA/TN 5Sheet Metal ____ 10
ROOFINGCorrugated Steel (6-inch end lap) 26-inch width 115 SF/SQ 10 27.5-inch width 122 SF/SQ 15
Wood Shingles 16 inch (4-inch exposure) 900 EA/SQ 15 18 inch (6-inch exposure) 600 EA/SQ 15 24 inch (8-inch exposure) 450 EA/SQ 15 Nails (4d) 4 LB/1000 shingles 15
Built-Up Roofing (4 ply) Sheathing paper 1 SQ/SQ 20 Felt 4 SQ/SQ 20 Pitch 125 LB/SQ 10 Gavel 400 LB/SQ 10
C-5
TABLE C-1. Conversion and Waste Factors (Continued)
Material Conversion % Waste
TILINGFloor Tile Asphalt, vinyl, asbestos ____ 10 Primer 5 GL/1000 SF 20 Adhesive 10 GL/1000 SF 20 Cleaner 5 GL/1000 SF 20 Wax 5 GL/1000 SF 20
Acoustic Tile Tile ____ 10 Cement 25 GL/1000 SF 20
GLASS AND GLAZINGGlass 8 X 12 75 panes/BX 10 10 X 16 45 panes/BX 10 12 X 20 30 panes/BX 10 14 X 24 22 panes/BX 10 16 X 28 16 panes/BX 10
Glazing Clips ____ 10
Putty 8 X 12 0.6 LB/pane 20 10 X 16 0.8 LB/pane 20 12 X 20 0.9 LB/pane 20 14 X 24 1.1 LB/pane 20 16 X 28 1.4 LB/pane 20
CAULKINGPrimer 2 GL/1000 FT 10
Compound (1/2 X 1/2) 13 GL/1000 FT 10
PAINTINGMetal Enamel 0.2 GL/100 SF 10 Zinc white 0.2 GL/100 SF 10 White lead 0.2 GL/100 SF 10
C-6
TABLE C-1. Conversion and Waste Factors (Continued)
Material Conversion % Waste
PAINTING (Continued)Wood Enamel 0.2 GL/100 SF 10 Zinc white 0.2 GL/100 SF 10 White lead 0.3 GL/100 SF 10 Varnish 0.2 GL/100 SF 10 Flat 0.2 GL/100 SF 10 Gloss 0.3 GL/100 SF 10
Brick, Concrete, Plaster Enamel 0.2 GL/100 SF 10 Zinc white 0.3 GL/100 SF 10 White lead 0.4 GL/100 SF 10 Varnish 0.2 GL/100 SF 10 Flat 0.3 GL/100 SF 10 Gloss 0.4 GL/100 SF 10 Size 0.3 GL/100 SF 10 Primer 0.3 GL/100 SF 10 Calcimine 0.4 GL/100 SF 10
PLUMBINGPipe Cast iron FT 10 Clay, vitrified FT 10 Plastic FT 10 Wrought iron, G.V., B.I. FT 10 Copper FT 10 Grooved steel (invasion) FT 10
Fittings Cast iron 2 inch and smaller EA 10 6 inch and smaller EA 10 8 inch and smaller EA 5 Clay and Concrete 4 inch to 10 inch EA 10 12 inch to 24 inch EA 5 Plastic EA 10 Wrought iron EA 10 Copper EA 10 Grooved steel EA 5
C-7
TABLE C-1. Conversion and Waste Factors (Continued)
Material Conversion % Waste
PLUMBING (Continued)Valves Globe and gate 2 inch and smaller EA 5 2-1/2 inch and larger EA 3 Check 2 inch and smaller EA 3 2-1/2 inch and larger EA 2 Special applications EA 0
Solder, Soft 1 LB/100 joints 10 Copper fittings 3/8 inch 0.5 LB 1/2 inch 0.75 LB 3/4 inch 1.0 LB 1 inch 1.25 LB 1-1/4 inch 1.7 LB 1-1/2 inch 1.8 LB 2 inch 2.4 LB 2-1/2 inch 3.2 LB 3 inch 3.9 LB 3-1/2 inch 4.5 LB 4 inch 5.5 LB
Solder, Hard Hard solder requirements equal 75% of soft per individual size 100 joints.
Flux Soft solder 10 LB/100 LB 10 Silver braze (hard) 7.5 LB/75 LB 2
Lead and Oakum Joint size LB/joint 2 inch 2 LB 3 inch 3 LB 4 inch 4 LB 5 inch 5 LB 6 inch 6 LB Oakum 1 LB per 5 LB lead 0
C-8
TABLE C-1. Conversion and Waste Factors (Continued)
Material Conversion % Waste
ELECTRICALConduit FT 5
Wire FT 10
Fittings EA 5
STEELBolts (field) Temporary 5 EA/TN 5 Permanent 25 EA/TN 5
Rivets (field) 25 EA/TN 10
Sheet Galvanized sheet ____ 10 Copper sheet ____ 10 Aluminum ____ 10 Black iron ____ 10
Electrode, Mild Steel, Carbon, and Stainless 1 LB/FT 1/8 inch thickness 0.064 3/16 inch thickness 0.113 1/4 inch thickness 0.158 5/16 inch thickness 0.232 3/8 inch thickness 0.345 1/2 inch thickness 0.581 5/8 inch thickness 0.874 3/4 inch thickness 1.395 1 inch thickness 2.148NOTE: Above figures are for fillets, butt,and groove welds with no backing strips.
D-1
APPENDIX D
Conversion Factors for English to Metric System
D-2
This page is blank
D-3
TABLE D-1. Conversion Factors for English to Metric System
Basic Metric Length Relationships
One Unit Millimeters Centimeters Meters KilometersEquals
Millimeter (mm) 1.0 0.1 0.001 0.000,001Centimeter (cm) 10.0 1.0 0.01 0.000,01 Meters (m) 1,000.0 100.0 1.0 0.001Kilometer (km) 1,000,000.0 100,000.0 1,000.0 1.000
Length Conversion Tables for English to Metric System
inches-------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------centimeters
centimeters----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- Iinches
feet------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- I Imeters
meters--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------feet I I Iyards----------------------------------------------------------------------------------meterss I I I Imeters-------------------------------------------------------------yards I I I I Imiles-----------------------------------kilometers I I I I I Ikilometers-------------miles I I I I I I I
1 0.62 1.61 1.09 .091 3.28 0.30 0.39 2.542 1.24 3.22 2.19 1.83 6.56 0.61 0.79 5.083 1.86 4.83 3.28 2.74 9.84 0.91 1.18 7.624 2.49 6.44 4.37 3.66 13.12 1.22 1.57 10.165 3.11 8.05 5.47 4.57 16.40 1.52 1.97 12.796 3.73 9.66 6.56 5.49 19.68 1.83 2.36 15.247 4.35 11.27 7.66 6.40 22.97 2.13 2.76 17.738 4.97 12.87 8.75 7.32 26.25 2.44 3.15 20.329 5.59 14.48 9.84 8.23 29.53 2.74 3.54 22.8610 6.21 16.09 10.94 9.14 32.81 3.05 3.93 25.4020 12.43 32.19 21.87 18.29 65.62 6.10 7.87 50.8030 18.64 48.28 32.31 27.43 98.42 9.14 11.81 76.2040 24.85 64.37 43.74 36.58 131.23 12.19 15.75 101.6050 31.07 80.47 54.68 45.72 164.04 16.24 19.68 127.0060 37.28 96.56 65.62 54.86 196.85 18.29 23.62 152.4070 43.50 112.65 76.55 64.00 229.66 21.34 27.56 177.8080 49.71 128.75 87.49 73.15 262.47 24.38 31.50 203..2090 55.92 144.34 98.42 82.80 295.28 27..43 35.43 228.60100 62.14 160.94 109.36 91.44 328.08 30.48 39.37 254.00
*Example: 3 yards = 2.74 meters, 3 feet = 0.91 meeters, 3 meters = 3.28 yards
Fractions of an Inch
Inch 1/16 1/8 3/16 1/4 5/12 3/8 7/16 ½ Centimeters 0.16 0.32 0.48 0.64 0.79 0.95 1.11 1.27
Inch 9/16 5/8 11/16 3/4 13/16 7/8 15/16 1 Centimeters 1.43 1.59 1.75 1.91 2.06 2.22 2.36 2.54
Units of Centimeters
Centimeters 0.1 0.2 0.3 0.4 0.5 0.6 0.7 0.8 0.9 1.0 Inches 0.04 0.08 0.12 0.16 0.20 0.24 0.28 0.31 0.35 0.39
D-4
TABLE D-1. Conversion Factors for English to Metric System (Continued)
Basic Metric Weight Relationships
One Unit Equals Grams Kilograms Metric Ton
Gram (gm) 1.0 0.0001 0.000,001Kilogram (kg) 1,000.0 1.000 0.001Metric ton 1,000,000.0 1,000.000 1.000
Weight(1) Conversion Tables for English to Metric Systems
ounces------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------gramsgrams------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------ounces I
pounds-----------------------------------------------------------------kilograms I I
kilograms---------------------------------------------pounds I I Ishort---------------------------------metric I I I Iton(2)----------------------------------ton I I I Imetric-------------short I I I I Iton(3)---------------ton I I I I I
1 1.10 .91 2.20 0.46 0.04 28.42 2.20 1.81 4.41 0.91 0.07 56.73 3.31 2.72 6.61 1.36 0.11 85.04 4.41 3.63 8.82 1.81 0.14 113.45 5.51 4.54 11.02 2.67 0.18 141.86 6.61 5.44 13.23 2.72 0.21 170.17 7.72 6.35 15.43 3.18 0.25 198.48 8.82 7.26 17.64 3.63 0.28 226.89 9.92 8.16 19.84 4.08 0.32 255.2
10 11.02 9.07 22.05 4.54 0.35 283.520 22.05 18.14 44.09 9.07 0.71 567.030 33.07 27.22 66.14 13.61 1.06 850.540 44.09 36.29 88.18 18.14 1.41 1134.050 55.12 45.36 110.23 22.68 1.76 1417.560 66.14 54.43 132.28 27.22 2.12 1701.070 77.16 63.50 154.32 31.75 2.47 1984.580 88.18 72.57 176.37 36.29 2.82 2268.090 99.21 81.65 188.42 40.82 3.17 2551.5
100 110.20 90.72 220.46 45.36 3.53 2835.0
*Example: Convert 28 pounds to kilograms28 pounds = 20 pounds + 8 poundsFrom the tables: 20 pounds = 9.07 kg, and 8 pounds = 3.63 kgTherefore: 28 pounds = 9.07 kg + 3.63 kg = 12.70 kg
The weights used for the English system are avoirdupois (common) weights.1
The short tone is 2,000 pounds2
The metric ton is 1,000 kg.3
D-5
TABLE D-1. Conversion Factors for English to Metric System (Continued)
Volume Conversion Tables for English to Metric System
CU. METERS-----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------CU. FEET----------CU.YARDS
CU. YARDS----------------------------------------------------------------CU. FEET--------CU. I IMETERS
CU. FEET--------------CU. YARDS-------CU. METERS I I I II I I I I I
1 0.037 0.028 27.0 0.76 35.3 1.312 0.074 0.057 54.0 1.53 70.6 2.623 0.111 0.085 81.0 2.29 105.9 3.924 0.148 0.113 108.0 3.06 141.3 5.235 0.185 0.142 135.0 3.82 176.6 6.546 0.212 0.170 162.0 4.59 211.9 7.857 0.259 0.198 189.0 5.35 247.2 9.168 0.296 0.227 216.0 6.12 282.5 10.469 0.333 0.255 243.0 6.88 317.8 11.77
10 0.370 0.283 270.0 7.65 353.1 13.0720 0.741 0.566 540.0 15.29 706.3 26.1630 1.111 0.850 810.0 22.94 1059.4 39.2440 1.481 1.133 1080.0 30.58 1412.6 52.8250 1.852 1.416 1350.0 38.23 1765.7 65.4060 2.222 1.700 1620.0 45.87 2118.9 78.4870 2.592 1.982 1890.0 53.52 2472.0 91.5680 2.962 2.265 2160.0 61.16 2825.2 104.6390 3.333 2.548 2430.0 68.81 3178.3 117.71
100 3.703 2.832 2700.0 76.46 3531.4 130.79
*Example: 3 cubic yards = 81.0 cubic feet
Volume: The cubic meter is the only common dimension used for measuring thevolume of solids in the metric system.
D-6
TABLE D-2. Conduit and Wire Conversion Factors
Wire Size
Wire Ampacity AWG Millimeters
20 12 2.5 25 10 4 30 8 6 45 6 10 60 4 16 80 3 25100 2 35130 1/0 50165 3/0 70200 4/0 95235 250 MCM 120280 280 150325 400 185415 500 240
600 MCM 300
Conduit Size
Inches Millimeters
3/4 201 25
1-1/4 30 1-1/2 40
2 50 2-1/2 60
3 75 3-1/2 90
4 100 4-1/2 125
D-7
TABLE D-3. Decimal Equivalent Chart
Inch Decimal Inch Decimal Inch Decimal Inch Decimal
1/32 .03125 5/32 .15625 9/32 .28125 13/32 .406251/16 .0625 3/16 .1875 5/16 .3125 7/16 .43753/32 .09375 7/32 .21875 11/32 .34375 15/32 .468751/8 .125 1/4 .250 3/8 .375 1/2 .500
17/32 .53125 21/32 .65625 25/32 .78125 29/32 .906259/16 .56125 11/16 .6875 13/16 .8125 15/16 .937519/32 .59375 23/32 .71875 27/32 .84375 31/32 .968755/8 .625 3/4 .750 7/8 .875 1 1.0000
D-8
TABLE D-4. Time Conversion Factors
Man-Hours to Minutes
Fractional Minutes Fractional MinutesMan-Hours Equivalent Man-Hours Equivalent
.017 1 0.517 31
.033 2 0.533 32
.050 3 0.550 33
.067 4 0.567 34
.083 5 0.583 35
.100 6 0.600 36
.117 7 0.617 37
.133 8 0.633 38
.150 9 0.650 39
.167 10 0.667 40
.183 11 0.683 41
.200 12 0.700 42
.217 13 0.717 43
.233 14 0.733 44
.250 15 0.750 45
.267 16 0.767 46
.283 17 0.783 47
.300 18 0.800 48
.317 19 0.817 49
.334 20 0.833 50
.350 21 0.850 51
.368 22 0.867 52
.383 23 0.883 53
.400 24 0.900 54
.417 25 0.917 55
.433 26 0.933 56
.450 27 0.950 57
.467 28 0.967 58
.483 29 0.983 59
.500 30 1.000 60
D-9
TABLE D-4. Time Conversion Factors
Man-Day to Hours
Fractional Man-HourMan-Day Equivalent
.1 0 hr. 48 min.
.2 1 hr. 36 min.
.3 2 hr. 24 min.
.4 3 hr. 12 min.
.5 4 hr. 0 min.
.6 4 hr. 48 min.
.7 5 hr. 36 min.
.8 6 hr. 24 min.
.9 7 hr. 12 min.
D-10
This page is blank
E-1
APPENDIX E
Average Temperature and Rainfall Chart
E-2
This page is blank
E-3
TABLE E-1. Average Temperature and Rainfall Outside The United States
Location Jan Feb Mar Apr May Jun Jul Aug Sep Oct Nov Jul
ANDROS IS. 77 77 79 81 84 87 88 89 88 85 81 79Bahamas 1.4 1.5 1.4 2.5 4.6 6.4 5.8 5.3 6.9 6.5 2.8 1.3
2 2 3 5 8 12 11 11 11 10 5 2
ARGENTIA 34 33 35 41 47 55 62 65 59 52 46 38Canada 4.8 3.8 3.1 2.9 2.5 2.4 3.2 3.2 3.1 3.6 4.9 4.5
19 9 8 8 6 6 6 7 6 8 9 10
BAHRAIN 70 72 79 90 99 106 108 108 103 95 84 73Saudi Arabia 0.8 0.4 0.4 0.1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0.1 0.8
2 1 1 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 2
BARBADOS IS. 83 84 84 85 86 86 86 87 86 86 85 84U.K. 0.8 1.0 0.6 2.1 5.1 2.7 6.5 6.9 4.3 7.7 7.4 3.4
3 4 3 5 10 5 12 15 10 10 10 11
BERMUDA 64 63 63 66 71 76 80 81 79 75 70 664.5 4.1 4.2 3.3 3.7 4.9 4.0 4.8 5.6 6.6 4.4 4.416 15 15 11 10 11 12 14 14 16 14 15
CRETE 60 62 62 69 76 83 86 87 82 75 69 62Khania 5.1 3.9 2.6 1.1 0.6 0.1 0 0.1 1.3 1.5 4.8 6.7
10.6 9.7 6.8 3.9 1.8 0.0 0 0.1 4.1 4.7 9.3 11.1
CUBA 76 76 78 79 81 83 84 84 83 82 80 78Guanto. Bay 1.1 0.9 1.1 1.0 3.0 2.4 1.0 1.9 3.5 6.1 1.6 1.0
3 3 3 3 6 6 3 6 8 11 6 4
DIEGO GARCIA 82 82 83 83 81 80 79 79 79 80 81 8212.8 8.9 6.5 6.6 6.0 5.2 5.2 9.1 8.9 12.9 5.9 6.721 20 16 15 15 16 16 14 17 18 13 15
GREECE 56 59 59 68 78 86 91 92 84 73 65 59Nea Makri 2.5 1.0 1.5 1.2 1.0 0.4 0.2 0.2 0.8 2.5 2.3 1.9
6 3 5 3 2 1 1 1 1 4 6 4
GUAM 81 81 81 83 83 84 84 84 83 83 83 82Anderson AFB 4.2 4.6 2.4 4.9 5.7 4.6 8.0 11.7 13.5 15.4 6.8 6.7
9 8 6 8 9 11 14 16 19 18 13 12
GUAM 80 80 80 81 82 82 82 81 81 81 81 81Agana 4.6 3.0 2.4 3.6 5.0 4.9 9.5 12.2 13.8 12.4 8.4 4.9
19 15 17 17 19 21 24 24 25 24 23 22
HOLY LOCH 43 44 48 53 59 64 66 65 61 54 47 43Scotland 4.6 3.2 2.5 2.3 2.6 2.4 3.1 3.3 3.6 4.7 4.1 4.2
10 9 7 6 7 6 8 8 8 9 9 10
NOTE: 1st Number - Average Monthly Temperature2nd Number - Average Monthly Precipitation3rd Number - Average Monthly Days of Rain
E-4
TABLE E-1. Average Temperature and Rainfall Outside the United States (Continued)
Location Jan Feb Mar Apr May Jun Jul Aug Sept Oct Nov Dec
ITALY 47 48 52 59 65 72 77 77 72 63 56 51Naples 3.7 2.8 2.9 2.9 2.0 1.5 0.7 0.9 2.9 5.3 4.5 4.7
11 8 9 8 5 4 1 2 4 8 7 13
JAPAN 39 41 46 56 64 70 77 80 73 62 53 44Atsugi 1.9 2.0 3.9 4.8 5.9 7.6 5.6 5.7 7.1 5.7 3.1 2.3
6 8 11 13 13 14 13 12 13 13 10 5
JAPAN 41 42 47 57 65 71 80 81 75 64 55 46Iwakuni 2.6 2.6 4.3 7.6 7.1 11.0 10.1 5.6 6.9 4.0 3.2 1.7
9 8 11 12 13 12 13 9 11 8 8 7
JAPAN 35 37 43 56 65 68 76 80 74 64 51 40Misawa AB 4.2 3.3 0.36 2.8 3.1 4.7 4.4 3.4 5.9 4.6 3.3 3.4
10 8 6 6 6 8 8 6 9 7 7 8
MIDWAY IS. 66 66 67 68 71 76 78 79 79 76 72 684.8 3.9 2.9 2.5 2.3 2.7 3.6 4.5 3.3 3.6 4.1 4.116 13 12 10 8 10 14 14 14 14 14 16
OKINAWA 60 61 64 69 75 79 83 83 81 75 71 64Futema 4.6 3.5 5.5 4.7 10.7 13.3 7.4 9.2 5.1 4.4 4.0 5.8
16 13 15 11 15 14 12 16 14 11 11 14
OKINAWA 67 67 70 76 80 85 89 88 87 81 75 70Makiminato 5.3 5.4 6.1 6.1 8.9 10.0 7.1 10.0 7.1 6.6 5.9 4.3
10.1 10.2 8.7 8.7 10.4 11 9.1 11 9.6 9 8.2 8.5
OKINAWA 65 66 70 75 80 84 88 87 86 81 75 69Shields 4.0 4.8 5.1 5.6 8.3 10.8 7.4 8.4 10.4 6.1 4.7 4.4
7.4 7.9 8.1 7.7 10.9 10.4 6.8 8.5 7.5 6.2 6 6.1
PHILIPPINES 80 81 83 85 85 83 81 81 81 82 82 81Cubi Point 0.1 0.1 0.2 0.6 8.6 23.2 31.8 33.5 25.7 7.2 3.0 0.7
1 1 2 2 10 20 25 25 22 12 7 4
PUERTO 77 72 78 79 81 82 83 83 83 86 80 79RICO 3.8 2.2 2.8 3.7 7.3 4.8 4.8 5.5 6.3 6.9 6.8 4.9Roosevelt Rds 17 14 13 14 19 18 21 19 19 18 18 19
SICILY 40 40 42 45 51 59 64 66 62 56 48 43Sigonella 2.8 1.8 1.7 1.9 1.1 0.5 0.2 0.6 1.0 5.8 1.3 3.0
11 8 9 8 5 4 1 2 4 8 7 13
SPAIN 53 55 57 61 66 70 75 75 72 67 58 53Rota 3.4 2.9 2.8 1.4 1.5 0.6 0.0 0.1 0.7 3.3 4.1 3.8
12 10 10 7 6 3 0 0 4 7 10 10
NOTE: 1st Number - Average Monthly Temperature2nd Number - Average Monthly Precipitation3rd Number - Average Monthly Days of Rain
E-5
TABLE E-2. Average Temperature and Rainfall for the United States
Location Jan Feb Mar Apr May Jun Jul Aug Sep Oct Nov Dec
ALASKA 34 33 35 38 41 45 49 52 48 43 37 34Adak 6.4 5.1 6.2 4.7 4.4 3.4 3.1 3.8 5.7 7.0 8.2 7.7
24 22 25 22 22 22 16 18 22 26 26 25
CALIFORNIA 50 53 56 58 60 63 64 64 66 63 57 51Alameda 3.6 2.2 2.2 1.2 0.4 0.2 0.0 0.0 0.2 1.1 2.3 3.3
10 8 8 5 2 1 0 1 1 4 8 10
CALIFORNIA 44 50 54 59 68 74 81 80 73 64 53 44Lemoore 1.1 1.1 0.7 0.6 0.3 0.1 0.0 0.0 0.1 0.3 1.2 1.0
6 6 4 4 2 1 0 0 1 2 6 8
CALIFORNIA 54 55 54 56 59 61 64 66 66 63 58 54Point Mugu 2.2 2.4 1.1 0.9 0.1 0.0 0.0 0.1 0.1 0.2 2.6 1.7
5 5 3 3 1 1 0 0 1 1 5 6
CALIFORNIA 55 56 58 60 62 65 69 71 69 66 61 57San Diego 1.7 1.2 1.2 0.6 0.2 0.1 0.0 0.1 0.1 0.3 1.2 1.4
6 5 5 4 2 1 0 0 1 2 5 5
CONNECTICUT 37 39 45 57 66 75 81 80 74 64 52 40New London 3.7 3.2 4.3 4.1 4.0 2.6 3.3 4.1 3.4 3.5 4.4 4.1
7 7 7 7 7 6 6 7 6 6 7 8
FLORIDA 57 59 64 71 77 81 83 83 80 73 64 58Jacksonville 2.4 3.1 3.1 2.5 3.3 5.1 6.0 7.5 6.0 3.9 1.4 2.2
7 8 7 6 8 12 15 15 13 9 6 7
FLORIDA 51 54 59 68 75 80 82 82 79 70 60 55Pensacola 3.7 4.5 4.1 3.6 3.0 5.0 5.9 5.9 7.0 4.2 2.6 3.9
10 10 10 6 7 9 13 12 10 6 7 9
HAWAII 66 66 662. 68 70 72 73 74 73 72 70 68Pearl Harbor 3.8 3.3 9 1.3 1.0 0.3 0.4 0.9 1.0 1.8 2.2 3.0
9 10 9 8 6 6 6 7 6 9 8 9
ILLINOIS 23 26 36 48 58 69 73 72 65 54 39 28Great Lakes 2.0 1.5 2.7 3.5 3.4 4.2 3.8 2.7 3.3 2.4 2.3 2.3
9 8 11 12 11 10 9 8 9 8 9 10
MARYLAND 42 46 51 66 74 83 87 85 79 68 55 44Annapolis 2.7 3.2 4.1 3.6 3.4 3.8 4.4 4.9 3.1 3.1 3.2 3.0
6 7 8 8 7 6 6 7 5 5 6 6
MISSISSIPPI 61 63 70 71 83 89 90 90 87 79 69 62Gulfport 4.0 4.7 5.9 4.9 4.6 5.3 7.1 6.3 6.1 3.2 3.2 4.9
8 9 8 8 8 8 10 9 9 6 6 9
RHODE ISLAND 67Davisville 2.530 31 39 48 57 73 71 65 55 45 34
3.6 3.7 3.9 3.8 3.8 2.7 4.0 3.1 2.6 4.3 4.311 9 10 11 11 9 9 8 7 11 1210
SOUTH 49 51 56 65 72 78 80 80 75 66 57 50CAROLINA 3.1 3.5 4.4 2.9 4.3 5.9 8.0 6.6 5.2 3.2 2.3 3.1Charleston 10 9 11 7 9 11 15 13 9 6 7 8
TENNESSEE 41 43 51 63 71 79 81 80 74 63 51 43Memphis 4.1 4.6 4.8 5.0 4.2 3.3 3.6 3.1 3.5 2.4 3.7 5.0
10 10 10 11 9 8 9 7 7 6 8 10
E-6
TABLE E-2. Average Temperature and Rainfall for the United States (Continued)
Location Jan Feb Mar Apr May Jun Jul Aug Sep Oct Nov Dec
VIRGINIA 41 42 48 58 66 74 78 77 72 62 53 44Oceana 4.1 3.7 3.5 2.5 3.5 3.2 5.1 6.0 4.4 4.1 2.8 3.1
10 10 11 10 10 8 11 10 8 7 8 8
WASHINGTON 40 42 44 48 53 57 59 59 56 51 45 41Whidbey Is. 2.4 1.7 1.6 1.4 1.1 1.2 0.6 0.8 1.2 2.0 2.3 2.8
18 13 14 12 8 8 5 6 8 13 16 18
NOTE: 1st Number - Average Monthly Temperature2nd Number - Average Monthly Precipitation3rd Number - Average Monthly Days of Rain
F-1
APPENDIX F
Standard Drawing Symbols(Partial List)
F-2
This page is blank
F-3
FIGURE F-1. Title Symbols
UP TO 11 15/16" TO BE EXPRESSED AS PROVIDE ADDITIONAL GRAPHICINCHES, 12" AND ABOVE TO BE IN SUMBOL LEGEND ON PLANS ASFEET AND INCHES. REQUIRED.
FIGURE F-2 Standard Symbols
F-4
FIGURE F-3. Structural and Welding
F-5
FIGURE F-4. Architectural (Materials) Symbols (Sheet1 of 3)
F-6
FIGURE F-4. Architectural (Materials) Symbols (Sheet 2 of 3)
F-7
FIGURE F-4. Architectural (Materials) Symbols (Sheet 3 of 3)
F-8
FIGURE F-5. Mechanical Symbols (Sheet 1 of 4)
F-9
FIGURE F-5. Mechanical Symbols (Sheet 2 of 4)
F-10
FIGURE F-5. Mechanical Symbold (Sheet 3 of 4)
F-11
FIGURE F-5. Mechanical Symbols (Sheet 4 of 4)
F-12
FIGURE F-6. Electrical Symbols (Sheet 1 of 3)
F-13
FIGURE F-6. Electrical Symbols (Sheet 2 of 3)
F-14
FIGURE F-6. Electrical Symbols (Sheet 3 of 3)
G-1
APPENDIX G
Project Planning Steps
G-2
This page is blank
G-3
PROJECT PLANNING STEPS
A. PRELIMINARY
1. Obtain and review plans and specifications.2. Write scope paragraph.3. Develop master activities.
NOTE: Between 10-15 activities keyed to majorconstruction phases or like activities, these shouldbe kept as rate specific as possible.
4. Place Master Activities into logical construction sequence (i.e., LogicNetwork)
5. Rough man-days per Master Activity (crew size X duration).6. Select construction methods.7. Identify lead time materials.8. Visit site, if practical.
B. DETAILED
1. Break Master Activities into Level III (or construction) activities.2. Develop construction activity subnets.
NOTE: Construction activities should be between 3-15days. There may be some exceptions, but muchsmaller and there are too many activities; muchlarger and there are too few.There should be noless than 15 and no more than 100 activities onany project.
3. Identify any training required and ensure it is provided.4. Write quantity estimates for detailed activities:
- permanent material- construction support- material (consumables- crew size and ratings- tools and equipment- durations- man-days
5. Complete Construction Activity Summary (CAS) sheet for each detailedactivity.
G-4
B. DETAILED (continued)
6. Compare activity materials to the Naval Construction Regiment (NCR) Bill of Materials (BM).
7. Make or request shop drawings and notify S-3 of requirements.8. Revise scope or methods, based on site visit.9. Make up safety and Quality Control (QC) Plans and identify major items
in each activity, using information contained on CAS sheets.10. Monitor message traffic Situation Reports (SITREPS) and
correspondence.11. Calculate critical path and float using activity durations and logic
diagram.12. Use deployment calendar to relate project days to calendar dates.13. Level resources and reschedule.14. Identify other information as necessary, such as any constraints on
start/finish. Examples: Utility tie-ins; outages; material delivery.15. Supply Required Delivery Dates (RDD) for materials to Naval
Construction Regiment.16. Develop Level II Master Activity charts.17. Develop milestones and, if minicomputer is to be used, enter the project
into the computer.
H-1
APPENDIX H
FORMS
H-2
This page is blank
________ of _________
ESTIMATOR WORK SHEET
PROJECT LOCATION PROJECT TITLE PROJECT NUMBER BM DATE PREPAREDNUMBER
PROJECT SECTION ACTIVITY NUMBER DRAWING NUMBER PREPARED BY: CHECKED BY:
DESCRIPTION REMARKSBM UNIT TOTAL
LINE OF QTYITEM ISSUE
BILL OF MATERIALPROJECT PROJECT TITLE AUTHORITY/ORIGINATOR BM NO. SECTION
M&S DEM SIG FUND DIS PRJ PRI JON ROSSERV & SERV &REQNR SUPP ADD ACCOUNTING DATA
7 30-35 44 45-50 51 53-53 54 57-59 60-61 62-64 72-77
COG NSN QTY DOCUMENT NUMBER ADVUNITOF
ISSUE
LI
DESCRIPTIONVENDOR/SOURCE UNIT TOTAL
INTENDED USE PRICE COST55-56 8-20 23-24 25-26 36-43 65-66
BM SUBMITTED BY/DATE BM APPROVED BY/DATE TARGET APPROVED/DATE PAGE BM PAGETOTAL TOTAL
OF
BM/MTO COMPARISON WORK SHEETACTIVITY MATERIAL BM LI BM MTO
NO. DESCRIPTION NO. QTY QTYU/I DIFF REMARKS
____ OF ____
ADD-ON BMPROJECT NUMBER PROJECT TITLE DATE MLO USE ONLY
BM NUMBER MASTER ACTIVITY NUMBER DRAWING NO. PREPARED BY: UNIT TOTAL REQUESITIOPRICE COST N
NUMBER
BM UNITITEM OF QTY DESCRIPTION JUSTIFICATIONNO. ISSUE
1. CREW LEADER DATE 5. OPS DATE MLO NOTES & REMARKS
2. PROJECT SUP. 6. MLO CHIEF
3. PROJECT MGR. 7. MLO SK
4. QC REP. 8. PROCUREMENT APPROVAL
MASTER ACTIVITY LISTING
PROJECT #_______________ PROJECT TITLE______________________________________________________________
MASTER ACT.NUMBER/TITLE MASTER ACTIVITY DESCRIPTION MD’s DURATION
FORM CREATED BY EAC (SCW) R. KRUPA
NCF LEVEL II
PROJECT # TOTAL MANDAY ESTIMATE: TASKED MANDAYS:
TITLE: JAN FEB MAR APR MAY JUN JUL AUG
ACT MASTER ACTIVITY MDS WT# %
10100%
2090%
3080%
4070%
50 60%
6050%
7040%
8030%
9020%
10010%
TOTAL0%
MD’s Scheduled This Period
Cummulative Mandays Scheduled
%Complete Scheduled (Plot)
MD’s Expended This Period
Cummulative mandays Expended
% Mandays Expended
% Work - In - Place (Plot)
Index-1
INDEX
Table PageNumber -A-
ACOUSTICS 4-104 Acoustical treatment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-99
AIR CONDITIONING 4-135 Air conditioners . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1284-136 Refrigerant recovery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-129
ASPHALT 4-2 Asphalt plant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-134-25 Paving, bituminos . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-29
-B-BLASTING
4-26 Drilling and blasting, rock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-29
-C-CARPENTRY
4-85 Board feet content . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-814-83 Board feet of lumber required per surface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-804-86 Board feet required for wood partitions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-824-91 Criteria for plywood flooring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-854-90 Criteria for plywood roof sheathing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-844-92 Finish carpentry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-864-84 Material required for built-up girders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-804-88 Material required for rafters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-834-89 Roof areas of pitched roof . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-844-80 Rough carpentry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-774-81 Sheathing and siding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-784-87 Variable spacing, number of studs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-824-93 Wire nails . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-864-82 Wood joists for floor spacing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-79
Index-2
CLIMATEE-1 Temperature, rainfall - outside United States . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . E-3E-2 Temperature, rainfall - United States . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . E-5
CONCRETE CONSTRUCTIONForm Work
4-39 Form work . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-39Concrete
4-53 Comprehensive strength . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-504-54 Conversion and waste factors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-514-52 Cubic feet to cubic yard . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-494-45 Finishing and curing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-434-47 Footings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-454-55 Material, weights, measures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-514-49 Material, for 100 SF of concrete . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-474-46 Miscellaneous and imbedded items . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-444-43 Mixing concrete . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-424-44 Placing concrete . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-434-50 Slabs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-474-48 Volume factors of various mixes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-454-51 Walls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-48
Reinforcing 4-41 Bars, numbers, sizes, areas, weights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-404-42 Reinforcing steel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-414-40 Reinforcing steel fabrication . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-40
CONVERSION - WASTE FACTORSC-1 Conversion and waste factors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . C-3
CONVERSION ENGLISH - METRIC D-2 Conduit/ wire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . D-6D-3 Decimal equivalent . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . D-7D-1 Length . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . D-3D-4 Time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . D-8D-1 Volume . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . D-4D-1 Weight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . D-5
-D-DOORS, WINDOWS, AND GLASS
4-99 Door installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-954-101 Glass and glazing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-96
Index-3
4-100 Window installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-96
DRAWING SYMBOLS Architectural (fig. F-4) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . F-6Electrical (fig. F-6) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . F-13Mechanical (fig. F-5) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . F-9Standard (fig. F-2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . F-4Structural and welding (fig. F-3) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . F-4Title (fig. F-1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . F-3
-E-
EARTHWORK 4-6 Acreage and areas . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-174-11 Bulldozer production . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-214-12 Clamshell . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-214-7 Clearing, grubbing, stripping . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-184-22 Compaction factors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-274-31 Culvert, concrete pipe . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-324-32 Culvert, galvanized . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-324-8 Demolition and removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-194-13 Draglines . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-214-28 Erosion control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-304-14 Excavation factors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-224-9 Excavation, general . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-204-27 Excavation, hand . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-304-15 Excavation, power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-234-17 Excavation, sheeting and shoring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-244-30 Fencing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-314-10 Front end loaders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-204-19 Dump trucks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-264-21 Graders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-274-29 Landscaping . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-314-18 Material weights, swell factors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-254-23 Rollers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-284-20 Scrapers, tractor, wheel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-264-16 Trencher/ditchers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-23
ELECTRICAL Alarm Systems
4-149 Fire alarm and signal system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-143
Index-4
Communication Systems 4-153 Intercommunication systems, installing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1464-151 Telephone, interior . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1444-150 Telephone, overhead construction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1444-152 Telephone, underground construction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-145
Overhead Systems 4-141 Athletic field lighting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1364-139 Conductors and devices, overhead primary and secondary . . . . . . . . . . 4-1344-141 Lighting, athletic facility . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1364-140 Lighting, street and security . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1354-137 Poles, setting, line work . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1334-138 Pole and anchor holes, digging . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-133
Transformer and Substation Systems 4-148 Substation installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-142
Underground Systems 4-142 Power systems, underground . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-137
Wiring Systems 4-146 Conduit spacing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1414-144 Electrical finish and trim, housing and barracks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1394-147 Electrical finish and trim, industrial . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1414-143 Electrical rough in, housing and barracks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1384-145 Electrical rough in, industrial . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-140
Electrical symbols (fig. F-6) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . F-12
EQUIPMENT Miscellaneous . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B-8NCF support unit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B-11Power tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B-10TA-01 table of allowance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B-5TA-02 table of allowance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B-6Tool kit description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B-1
-F-
FINISHESAcoustical
4-104 Acoustical treatment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-99
Floor Tile4-108 Floor, resilient, mastic requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1024-106 Floor, tile estimating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-101
Index-5
4-107 Floor, tile waste allowances . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1014-105 Flooring, tiling soft . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-100
Painting4-116 Coverage for paints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1074-115 Drying times . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1064-117 Painting, exterior . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1084-114 Painting, interior . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1054-113 Painting, metal fence . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1044-112 Painting, structural and miscellaneous steel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-104
Plaster and Stucco4-103 Cement, stucco, plaster, material requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-994-102 Portland cement, stucco, and plaster . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-99
Wall Covering 4-110 Joint compound and tape, ready mix . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1034-111 Wallboard, fastener requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1034-109 Wall covering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-102
-H-HEATING
4-133 Boilers, heating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1264-134 Duct, sheet metal, fiberglass . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1274-132 Furnaces, warm air . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1254-133 Heaters, hot water storage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1264-133 Tanks, expansion . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-126
-M-MASONRY
4-58 Block, brick, and rubble masonry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-574-62 Conversion units: masonry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-604-60 Grout, volume in concrete block walls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-594-63 Material weights and measures: masonry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-614-59 Tile masonry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-584-61 Walls, CMU, maximum unsupported height during construction . . . . . . 4-594-57 Walls, concrete masonry, height by courses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-564-56 Walls, concrete masonry, length by stretcher . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-55
MECHANICAL CONSTRUCTION Air Conditioning
4-135 Air conditioners . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1284-136 Refrigerant recovery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-129
Heating 4-133 Boilers, heating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-126
Index-6
4-134 Duct, sheet metal and fiberglass . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1274-132 Furnaces, warm air . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-125
Mechanical Symbols (fig. F-5) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . F-84-133 Heaters, hot water storage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1264-133 Tanks, expansion . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-126
Pipe and Fittings4-121 Cast iron no hub pipe and fittings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1174-129 Compressed air systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1234-126 Concrete pipe . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1204-125 CPVC and PVC pipe, solvent welded, and fittings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1204-122 Copper pipe, type K, L, M, with cast or wrought fittings . . . . . . . . . . 4-1174-135 Dehumidifiers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1284-130 Fire protection systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1244-131 Galley equipment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1244-127 Insulation and lagging, pipe . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1214-128 Plumbing, finish . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1224-135 Refrigerators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1284-123 Steel pipe, threaded or flanged . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1184-124 Steel pipe, grooved . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-119
METALS 4-74 Butt joints, square groove, electrode and wire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-694-73 Butt joints, "V" groove, electrode and wire requirements . . . . . . . . . . . 4-694-72 Fillet welds, horizontal, electrode and wire requirements . . . . . . . . . . . 4-684-78 Steel angles, weight of . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-734-75 Steel bars, flat, weight of in LBS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-704-76 Steel bars, square, round, weight of in LBS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-714-71 Steel floor plates, standard diamond, weight of . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-684-70 Steel plates, weights in pounds per square foot . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-684-69 Steel, sheets, black, galvanized, flat, corrugated, gage of . . . . . . . . . . . 4-674-77 Steel, standard channel, weight of . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-724-65 Steel, structural, erection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-654-64 Steel, structural, fabrication . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-654-66 Steel, structural, flame cutting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-664-67 Steel, structural, welding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-664-79 Steel tanks, bolted . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-744-68 Steel, welded pipe lines . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-67
Structural and welding symbols (fig. F-3) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . F-4
MOISTURE PROTECTION 4-96 Insulation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-904-97 Insulation, batts, fastener requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-91
Index-7
4-98 Insulation, loose fill . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-914-95 Sheet metal work . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-904-94 Waterproofing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-89
-P-PAINTING
4-116 Coverage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1074-115 Drying times . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1064-117 Painting, exterior . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1084-114 Painting, interior . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1054-113 Painting, metal fence . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1044-112 Painting, structural and miscellaneous steel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-104
PIERS, PILING 4-34 Pier hardware, miscellaneous . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-334-33 Piledriving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-334-37 Pile bracing and capping . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-344-35 Pile dolphins, wood . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-344-38 Pile extraction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-354-36 Pile framing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-34
PLANT OPERATION 4-2 Asphalt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-134-3 Rock crushing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-13
PLASTER 4-103 Cement, stucco, plaster . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-994-102 Portland cement, stucco, plaster . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-99
PIPE 4-121 Cast iron no hub pipe and fittings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1174-129 Compressed air systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1234-126 Concrete pipe . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1204-125 CPVC and PVC pipe, solvent welded, and fittings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1204-122 Copper pipe, type K, L, M, with cast or wrought fittings . . . . . . . . . . 4-1174-135 Dehumidifiers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1284-130 Fire protection systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1244-131 Galley equipment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1244-127 Insulation and lagging, pipe . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1214-128 Plumbing, finish . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-122
Index-8
4-135 Refrigerators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1284-123 Steel pipe, threaded or flanged . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1184-124 Steel pipe, grooved . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-119
PROJECT PLANNING Add-On BM work sheet (fig. 2-4) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-8Activity block (fig. 5-1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-5Backward pass (fig. 5-7) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-10Bill of material (fig. 2-2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-6BM/MTO comparison work sheet (fig. 2-3) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-7Estimating work sheet (fig. 2-1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-5Equipment estimate (fig. 3-1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-4Finish-to-finish logic (fig. 5-5) (fig. 5-10) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-7/5-8Floats (fig. 5-8) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-10Forward pass (fig.5-6) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-9Log (fig. 5-3) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-6Precedence diagram (fig. 5-2)(5-11) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-6/5-13Production efficiency (fig.4-1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-7Rigid frame building (fig. 5-11) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-12Start-to-start logic (fig. 5-4)(fig. 5-9) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-7
-S-
SITE WORK Asphalt
4-25 Paving, bituminous . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-294-24 Seal coats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-28
Blasting and Quarring 4-26 Drilling and blasting, rock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-29
Clearing 4-6 Acreage and areas . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-174-7 Clearing, grubbing, stripping . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-184-8 Demolition and removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-19
Compaction 4-22 Compaction factors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-274-23 Rollers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-28
Earthmoving 4-19 Dump trucks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-264-18 Material weights and swell factors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-254-20 Scrapers, tractor, wheel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-26
Index-9
Excavation 4-11 Bulldozer production . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-214-12 Clamshell . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-214-13 Draglines . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-224-9 Excavation, general factors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-204-27 Excavation, hand . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-304-10 Front end loaders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-20
Grading 4-21 Graders, motor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-27
Miscellaneous 4-31 Culvert, concrete pipe . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-324-32 Culvert, galvanized . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-324-28 Erosion control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-304-30 Fencing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-314-29 Landscaping . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-31
Trenching4-14 Excavation factors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-224-17 Excavation, sheeting and shoring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-244-15 Excavators, power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-234-16 Trencher/ditchers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-23
Waterfront 4-34 Pier hardware, miscellaneous . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-334-33 Piledriving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-334-37 Pile bracing and capping . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-344-35 Pile dolphins, wood . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-344-38 Pile extraction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-354-36 Pile framing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-34
SPECIALTIES 4-119 Bulletin boards, chalkboards, directory boards
bathroom accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1114-120 Cabinets, wood . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1124-118 Metal products . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1114-118 Partitions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-111
SUPPORT ITEMS4-5 Barricades . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-144-5 Construction, temporary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-144-5 Rubbish shute . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-144-4 Scaffolding, runways, ramps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-14
Index-10
TEMPERATURE - RAINFALL E-1 Outside United States . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . E-3E-2 United States . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . E-5
WALLBOARD 4-111 Fastener requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1034-110 Joint compound and tape, ready mix . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1034-109 Wall covering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-102
WORK ELEMENT Checklist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . A-1Plant operations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . A-6
4-2 Asphalt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-134-3 Rock crushing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-13
Roads, paving, walks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . A-74-4 Scaffoldings, runways, ramps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-14
Structures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . A-34-5 Temporary construction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-14
Utilities, outside . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . A-5Waterfront construction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . A-7
4-34 Pier hardware, miscellaneous . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-334-33 Piledriving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-334-37 Pile bracing and capping . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-344-35 Pile dolphins, wood . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-344-38 Pile extraction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-354-36 Pile framing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-34
PUBLICATION DEFICIENCY/EVALUATION REPORT
1. Publication No. 2. Publication Title
3. Submitting Organization 5. Type of OrganizationAE______ EFD/PWO______
OICC/ROICC______ User______
Contractor______ Other______4. Address
6. Problem Areas a. Paragraph number and wording:
b. Recommended wording:
c. Reason/rational for recommendation:
USERS EVALUATION OF PUBLICATION
Excellent Good Fair Poor Complete Incomplete
7. Remarks
8. Submitter's Name, Rank, Rate, or Grade and Title Work Telephone Number Date
9. Signature of Department Officer Date
PLEASE CLOSE WITH TAPE - DO NOT STAPLE - THANK YOU
Fold Here___________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________
DEPARTMENT OF THE NAVY
______________________Official Business
COMMANDING OFFICERCIVIL ENGINEER SUPPORT OFFICE, CODE 1574NAVAL CONSTRUCTION BATTALION CENTER1000 23RD AVENUEPORT HUENEME, CA 93043 4301
_____________________________________________________________________Fold Here
COMMUNICATION:COMMUNICATION:THE KEY TO EFFECTIVE MANAGEMENT!
CONTACTS AND TELEPHONE NUMBERS
Subject Code Phone DIRECTOR 15 1870ABFC/TOA Component Shipping 1574 1915Assistance Visits 1575 3153CASEMIS Information System 1535 3296CESE Fleet 1575 3204CESE Non-Rolling Stock Tech. and Procurement 1536 2468CESE Shore Activities 1531 3099CESMIS Information System 1574 1883Drawings, Facilities, ABFC 1536 2468Drawings, Storage and Retrieval 1562 5778ECMS Information System 1564 6094Fleet (NCF) and Shore Activities 1573 1895Fleet (NSE) Amphibious 154B 2780Industry Interface CCB CD-ROM 158 5661Industry Interface Equipment 1564 5537Industry Interface Facilities 1562 5460Maintenance 1574 1922Mil. and Fed. Specs. Equipment 1564 5537Mil. and Fed. Specs. Facilities 1562 5460Mil. and Fed. Specs. Guide Specifications 158 5661NCF Training 152 3065NCR Curriculum Development 1521 5926Provisioning 1574 1916Publications, CASEMIS manuals 1535 3296Publications, CESE, Maint. Bulletin 1574 1856Publications, CESMIS manuals 1574 1883Publications, NAVFAC, user manuals 1574 1816Publications, Rate Training Manuals 1521 3083Publications, SAMMS manuals 1574 1883Publications, Sealift Support Manuals 1543 2998PWRMS CESE Rolling Stock 1575 3204PWRMS Non-2C Cognizance 1573 1895PWRMS Non-Rolling Stock 1573 1895SAMMS Information System 1574 1883Tables of Allowance 1571 1898Test and Evaluation 1532 3081
FAX Number: 5798 DSN prefix: 551- COMMERCIAL (805) 982-
Written and Producedby
CIVIL ENGINEER SUPPORT OFFICENAVAL CONSTRUCTION BATTALION CENTER
1000 23RD AVENUEPORT HUENEME, CA 93043-4301